ipLDK 20 Programming Manual Manual PDF
ipLDK 20 Programming Manual Manual PDF
Table of contents
Abbreviations and Keywords Table................................................................. 1
Section 1. Introduction ................................................................................... 8
1.1 THE STRUCTURE OF PROGRAMMING MANUAL ..........................................8
1.2 MANUAL USAGE ...............................................................................................9
Section 2. System Feature ........................................................................... 10
2.1 HOW TO GET INCOMING CALL .....................................................................10
2.1.1 Ring Assignment .................................................................................................. 10
2.1.2 PLA (Preferred Line Answer) ................................................................................ 12
2.1.3 DID(Direct Inward Dialing).................................................................................... 13
2.1.4 DISA(Direct Inward System Access) .................................................................... 16
2.1.5 CCR(Customer Call Routing) with VMIB .............................................................. 17
2.1.6 CO Line Name......................................................................................................19
2.1.7 UNA (UNIVERSAL NIGHT ANSWER).................................................................. 20
2.2 HOW TO ACCESS OUTGOING CALL.............................................................21
2.2.1 Basic access ........................................................................................................21
2.2.2 Call time restriction...............................................................................................23
2.2.3 CO Line Queuing..................................................................................................24
2.2.4 CO Step Call – Analog Only ................................................................................. 25
2.2.5 Emergency Call service........................................................................................ 25
2.2.6 Hot Line & Warm Line .......................................................................................... 26
2.2.7 LCR (Least Call Routing) ..................................................................................... 27
2.2.8 Memory dialing ..................................................................................................... 33
2.2.8.1 ACNR (Auto Call Number Redial).............................................................................. 33
2.2.8.2 Last Number Redialing .............................................................................................. 34
2.2.8.3 Save Number Redialing............................................................................................. 34
2.2.8.4 Station Speed Dialing................................................................................................. 35
2.2.8.5 System Speed Dialing................................................................................................ 37
2.2.9 Private Line .......................................................................................................... 39
2.3 REROUTING FEATURE ..................................................................................40
2.3.1 Call Forward .........................................................................................................40
2.3.1.1 Call Forward, Unconditional....................................................................................... 41
2.3.1.2 Call Forward, Busy .................................................................................................... 42
2.3.1.3 Call Forward, No Answer ........................................................................................... 43
2.3.1.4 Call Forward, Busy/No Answer .................................................................................. 44
2.3.1.5 Call Forward, Station Off-net (Unconditional, No answer) ......................................... 45
2.3.1.6 Call Forward, Incoming CO Off-net (ATD only).......................................................... 46
2.3.1.7 Call Forward, Follow Me ............................................................................................ 47
2.3.1.8 SLT Call Forward ....................................................................................................... 48
2.3.1.9 Preset Call Forward ................................................................................................... 49
2.3.1.10 DID/DISA Reroute Destination (UK only)................................................................. 49
2.3.2 Call Transfer .........................................................................................................50
2.3.2.1 Call Transfer to CO Line ............................................................................................ 51
2.3.2.2 Call Transfer to Station .............................................................................................. 52
2.3.3 Holding and Parking ............................................................................................. 54
2.3.3.1 Hold ........................................................................................................................... 54
2.3.3.2 Hold Preference......................................................................................................... 55
2.3.3.3 Automatic Hold........................................................................................................... 56
2.3.3.4 Park ........................................................................................................................... 56
2.3.4 Pickup ..................................................................................................................57
2.3.4.1 Directed Call Pick Up................................................................................................. 57
i
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Table of Contents
ii
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Table of Contents
iii
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Table of Contents
iv
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Table of Contents
v
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Table of Contents
vi
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Table of Contents
vii
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Table of Contents
viii
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Table of Contents
ix
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Table of Contents
x
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Table of Contents
xi
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Table of Contents
xii
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Table of Contents
xiii
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Table of Contents
xiv
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Table of Contents
xv
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Table of Contents
xvi
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Abbreviation and Keywords Table
1
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Abbreviation and Keywords Table
2
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Abbreviation and Keywords Table
3
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Abbreviation and Keywords Table
4
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Abbreviation and Keywords Table
5
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Abbreviation and Keywords Table
6
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Abbreviation and Keywords Table
7
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Introduction
Section 1. Introduction
This programming manual is designed to provide as general features for the IP LDK-20
System.
It also explains the procedure of ADMIN Programming of the IP LDK-20 System using
DKTU and PC.
Section 1 Introduction
Introduces the structure of this manual and usage of this programming manual.
Section 6 Index
8
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Introduction
Abbreviation table
Before getting started, you understand the terms and abbreviations in contents. Therefore
we summarized the abbreviations and keyword table using this programming manual on
first page.
In section 2, the feature is grouped according to the situation. The structure is divided into 5
parts : Description, Operation, Condition, Reference, Admin programming.
Each part briefly describes as below :
This section explains the function of each button used for ADMIN programming in section 3
and section 4. Also describes basic programming from 100 to 108 when the LDK system is
installed.
Some PGM have already been programmed at factory. Others are needed to ADMIN
programming to operate normally. The detailed information is described in section 3.
This section is related to the section 2 “ADMIN programming” to operate the feature.
This section focuses on the procedure of ADMIN programming. And briefly explains the
item of ADMIN programming on description. To help the item understand, link to the related
feature and contents on reference. The detailed information is described in section 4.
This section provide the table for expert. So beginner or intermediator refer to the section 3
or section 4 in ADMIN programming.
9
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
If there is an incoming call through CO Line which is ring assigned, the pre-assigned destination gets
the call. The destination can be Station, Hunt Group(see Ref.1), or VMIB announcement(see Ref.2).
If a destination station is busy, the incoming call gives muted ring signal, so the station user can notice
the incoming CO Call.
Following Figure 2.1.1 describes the Ring Assignment of incoming CO call. The ring can be assigned
to stations, hunt group or VMIB announcement.
LDK System
Station A Station B
PSTN
Hunt Group
VMIB announcement
Operation
Example
Make Station 100 ~ 105 ring at the incoming call from CO Line 1~8 at Day Mode, and station 110 start
to ring after 9 seconds.
1. Set CO Service type as Normal at ADMIN 140.
2. At ADMIN 144, select CO Line range 01~08 and press FLEX 1 (Day Mode).
3. Dial 1 (Station), and enter station range 100105.
4. To make the stations ring instantly, dial delay value 0 (without delay).
5. Save the changed setting by pressing [HOLD/SAVE] button.
6. Press FLEX 1(Day Mode) again without exiting ADMIN 144, and press 1 (Station) again.
7. Enter station range as 110110, and dial 3 as delay value. Save it again.
→ When there’s an incoming CO Call through CO Line 1 ~ 8 at Day mode, the station 100 ~ 105
starts to ring instantly. If one of the station answer the call, other stations stop to ring. After 9
seconds, if the call is still not answered, station 110 starts to ring.
Make Hunt group 620 ring at the incoming call from CO Line 1~8 at Night Mode.
1. Check if CO Service type is set to Normal at ADMIN 140.
2. Check if Hunt group 620 is assigned properly at ADMIN 190.
3. At ADMIN 144, select CO Line range 01~08 and press FLEX 2 (Night Mode).
4. Dial 2 (Hunt), and enter Hunt group number 620.
10
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Make the VMIB announcement 01 played at the incoming call from CO Line 1~8 at Weekend Mode.
1. Check if CO Service type is set to Normal at ADMIN 140.
2. Check if VMIB announcement 01 is recorded properly at system attendant’s station (see Ref.4).
3. At ADMIN 144, select CO Line range 01~08 and press FLEX 3 (Weekend Mode).
4. Dial 3 (VMIB), and enter VMIB announcement number 01.
5. To make the CO Line released after VMIB announcement, enter #.
6. Save the changed setting by pressing [HOLD/SAVE] button.
→ When there’s an incoming CO Call through CO Line 1 ~ 8 at Weekend mode, the VMIB
announcement played. If # is entered, the line is released.
Condition
1. Any CO Line Ring can be assigned to multiple stations. (All CO Line Ring may be assigned to all
station.)
2. Each ring to station can be delayed by ADMIN programming.
3. The ring assignment is individually applied to Day, Night, weekend or On-demand ring mode(see
Ref.3).
4. To receive incoming CO Call, the DKTU should have {CO} button or {LOOP} button.
5. Every CO Line ring is assigned to Attendant station by default.
Reference
1. Hunt Group : 2.2.5.4
2. VMIB announcement : 2.2.5.3
3. Ring Mode : 2.13.8
4. System Attendant : 2.13 ( description - main Attendant )
5. Hunt Group : 2.6
Admin Programming
CO Service Type 4.2.1 (PGM 140 – FLEX 9)
CO Line Ring Assignment 4.2.5 (PGM 144)
Weekly Time Table 4.11.6 (PGM 233)
Hunt Group 4.(PGM 190)
11
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
If PLA service is enabled and there’re several incoming CO Calls(type of Transferred Call, Recalled
Call, queued Call, and Normal Incoming Call) at the same time, the first answered Call is chosen by
PLA priority.
Default :
Transferred Call → Recalled Call → Normal Incoming Call → CO Line Queued Call
Operation
Example
If there’s multiple CO Call is ringing at a station and the station answers the call, the call which
has the highest priority is answered first. Refer to Figure 2.1.2.
CO Line Recalling
Condition
1. When more than one line is ringing at a station and Preferred Line Answer is enabled, the priority
of answer is as follows by default;
CO Line Transfer Call → CO Line Recalling → CO Line Incoming Call → CO Line Queued
Call
2. “Automatic Speaker Select” feature should be enabled for Preferred Line Answer.
3. The priority of CO Line for preferred line answer can be changed by Admin Programming.
Admin Programming
Preferred Line Answer 4.1.3.7 (PGM 112 – FLEX 7)
Automatic Speaker Selection 4.1.2.1 (PGM 111 – FLEX 1)
PLA Priority 4.4.14 (PGM 173)
12
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
This feature allows CO incoming calls to access to specific destination. There is no relation with
Attendant, and this feature enables direct access to desired station, Hunt group, VMIB announcement,
Speed, and Page.
There are 3 types of DID Conversion and it can be set by ADMIN Programming (ADMIN 143-FLEX 4).
- Type 0: In an incoming DID digits, select some digits which are received digits by ADMIN Programming. The
selected digits will be converted by DID Conversion type(ADMIN 146 – FLEX 5/FLEX 6).
- Type 1: The incoming DID digits are the destination number. There is no conversion.
- Type 2: With result of DID Conversion type 1, convert by the Flexible DID table (ADMIN 231) additionally.
Operation
Example . 1
To make DID call by DID Digit Conversion as the figure 2.1.3 below,
850 2629
129
Example . 2
To make DID call by Flexible DID Table as the figure 2.1.4 below,
129
13
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
1. When a DID is received at a busy station, the call is waited in the station for DID/DISA Answer
timer.
2. Flexible DID Table is applied according to Day/Night Ring Mode (see Ref.2)
3. Destination of Flexible DID Table can be station, Hunt group, VMIB announcement, Drop after
VMIB announcement, System Speed(see Ref.3), Internal Page, External Page or,
Internal/External/All Call Page(see Ref.4).
4. If the call is not answered or the number was invalid, the call is routed by DID/DISA Destination.
5. The DID call to a busy station can be placed on a waiting stage according to admin programming to KTU
and SLT.
Reference
1. DID Digit Conversion Mask 4.2.7.6
2. Weekly Time Table 4.11.3
3. System Speed Dialing 2.2.8.5
4. Paging Features 2.8
Admin Programming
DID Conversion Type 4.2.4.4 (PGM 143 – FLEX 4)
DID Digit Conversion Mask 4.2. (PGM 146 – FLEX 2)
Automatic Speaker Selection 4.1.2.1 (PGM 111 – FLEX 1)
DID/DISA Destination 4.2. (PGM 167)
DID Call Wait 4.1.5.16 (PGM 114 – FLEX 17)
14
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
[Flow chart]
RING ON or SETUP
NO
DID LINE ?
YES
DIGIT INPUT
NO
ISDN LINE ?
YES
NO
NO
ADM 143
(DID_RM) ?
YES
ADM 201
Ignore digit until DID_RM
(COLP TBL) ?
NO
YES
TYPE_0 TYPE_1
DID Dgt Conversion Ring on
DID Conversion type
ADM 146
to the valid extension
TYPE_2
Flex DIDTBL
ADM 231
15
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
This feature allows CO incoming calls to access to specific destination without attendant’s answering.
Compared with DID(see Ref.1), there is no digit conversion in DISA.
On seizing incoming CO Line, system gives VMIB announcement(see Ref.2) or dial tone. Then the
caller dials additional digit to access desired destination.
Operation
DISA Line Assignment
1. [TRANS/PGM] + 140
2. Enter the CO Line range to be assigned to DISA Line.
3. [FLEX 2] + Ring type + [FLEX 1] + ‘1’ + [HOLD/SAVE] : DISA Activate
- Ring type : FLEX 1-Day, FLEX 2-Night, FLEX 3-Weekend, FLEX 4-On-demand
4. [FLEX 2] + Ring type + [FLEX 2] + ‘01~70’ + [HOLD/SAVE] : VMIB Greeting Assign
To use DISA,
1. Seize the DISA Line of the system.
2. When the tone or announcement is heard, dial the desired station/ hunt group number then the
station/hunt group receives the call .
3. After connected with the system, user can dial the CO Access Code(e.g : 8801) to call outside
of the system again by seizing another CO Line.
Condition
1. You can assign VMIB announcement instead of intercom dial tone for DISA line.
2. If the DISA Authorization Code is enabled for a DISA Line, DND warning tone or VMIB
announcement, guiding to enter DISA Authorization Code, is heard and the Authorization
Code(see Ref.3) should be entered. And the dial tone will be heard.
3. Each DISA Line may be assigned as a full-time DISA or night mode only. Night mode DISA
operates as normal CO Line in the Day mode.
4. If the VMIB announcement number is stored with “#”, the CO Line will be dropped after the VMIB
announcement is played.
5. If the DISA Authorization Code is enabled for a DISA CO Line, the user should enter DISA
Authorization Code to access the CO Line.
6. If the DISA Authorization Code is disabled, the permission is determined by “CO to CO COS” &
“CO COS” (see Ref.4).
7. If the DISA Authorization Code is enabled, the Authorization Code should be entered to access
outgoing CO Line. If the Authorization Code is matched with the Authorization Code of station, the
user may access the CO Line depending on “STA COS” & “CO COS”. If the Authorization Code is
matched with the Authorization Code of system, it is determined by “CO to CO COS” and “CO
COS”.
Reference
1. DID : 2.1.3
2. VMIB announcement : 2.11
3. Authorization Code : 2.5.2
4. COS : 2.5.4
16
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Admin Programming
DISA Line Assignment 4.2.1 (PGM 140 – FLEX 1)
DISA Account Code 4.2.2.3 (PGM 141 – FLEX 3)
VMIB announcement 4.4.1.4 (PGM 160 – FLEX 4)
CO to CO COS Assignment 4.4.7 (PGM 166)
Weekly Time Table 4.11.6 (PGM 233)
Description
CCR is incoming CO Call type of DISA/DID(see Ref.1, Ref.2), the user can route the destination by
pressing only one digit. If user press a certain digit, corresponding VMIB announcement is played.
Then, user press the desired digit again. In that way, call routing is established.
Or a user may access the desired destination directly by dialing the station number, hunt group
number or VMIB announcement (see Ref.3).
The Figure 2.1.5 below describes the CO incoming call using CCR with VMIB announcement.
IP LDK System
PSTN
Operation
1. When a call is answered by a system programmed with CCR, system gives a VMIB announcement
to caller. VMIB announcement gives a choice of destination.
2. The caller may select a destination by dialing according to VMIB announcement.
17
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
1. The CCR feature is only supported for DID and DISA.
2. To use CCR feature for DID, VMIB should be assigned for Flexible DID Destination (ADMIN 231).
3. If a caller dials full destination number, the call will be routed to the destination directly by system
numbering plan.
4. If a caller dials one digit and wait for a while, the LDK system will compare the digit with CCR
Table. If the digit is matched with CCR Table, of which the bin number is same with VMIB
announcement, the call is routed to programmed destination.
5. If the dialed digit is invalid, the caller can retry to enter digit for 3 times. DISA Retry counter is
also programmable. If the caller fails until the counter expired, the call is routed to recall
destination or disconnected after error tone.
6. VMIB announcement 01~70 may be used for CCR.
7. Call routing will be operated with current VMIB announcement.
8. The maximum CCR depth is 10.
9. The external user can dial digit while the VMIB announcement is being played or the digit should
be entered within inter-digit time (5sec) after the announcement is ended.
10. If the caller does not dial any digit within inter-digit time (5sec), the call will be routed to the ring
assigned stations or disconnected after error tone.
11. If a user presses ‘#’ button while CCR is operated, CCR goes to the first step.
12. If a user presses ‘ ’ button, CCR goes to the previous step.
13. The call can be dropped directly after VMIB announcement if VMIB drop is selected at CCR Table.
14. If a call is routed to System Speed Dial, the call is routed to the Speed Dial destination. If the CO
Call is assigned at the System Speed Dial, the routing is same as Incoming CO Off-net Call
Forward.
Reference
1. DID : 2.1.3
2. DISA : 2.1.4
3. VMIB announcement : 2.11
4. DISA Authorization Code : 4.2.2.3
5. System Speed Dial : 2.2.8.5
18
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Admin Programming
Flexible DID Table 4.11.4 (PGM 231)
DID Digit Conversion Table 4.2.7.5 / 4.2.7.6 (PGM 146 – FLEX 5/ FLEX 6)
DISA Retry Counter 4.4.1.4 (PGM 160 – FLEX 4)
CCR Inter-digit Timer 4.5.1.15 (PGM 180 – FLEX 15)
Inter-digit Timer 4.5.2.8 (PGM 181 – FLEX 8)
DID/DISA Destination 4.4.8 (PGM 167)
CCR Table 4.11.2 (PGM 228)
Description
This feature assign name to each CO Line. The stations with LCD, including the attendant, display the
programmed CO Line name in place of the ‘LINE XXX’ message.
This is applied to all conditions where the ‘LINE XXX’ message is displayed. However, SMDR (see
Ref.1) continues to print out the line number in place of the programmed name. If the CO Line name is
not programmed, the ‘LINE XXX’ display is default.
Condition
1. CO Line name can be assigned to each CO Line.
2. Each CO Line name can be assigned up to 12 characters.
3. If CO Line Name Display is set to OFF at ADMIN 142 – FLEX 1, the CO Line Name is not displayed
even if the name is programmed.
Reference
1. SMDR : 2.12
Admin Programming
CO Line Name Display 4.2.3.1(PGM 142 – FLEX 1)
CO Line Name Assignment 4.2.3.2(PGM 142 – FLEX 2)
19
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
If the CO Line is Programmed to UNA, user can pick up incoming CO Calls by dialing Night Answer
code 569 (see Ref.1) regardless of the pick-up group.
Figure 2.1.6 below describes the UNA service. If there’s incoming CO Call at Night Mode (see Ref.2),
the station B can pick up the call although station A and B is not belong to a pick up group.
IP LDK System
PSTN STA A
STA B
: Dial 569(UNA Code)
Operation
To pick-up a call in night mode,
1. Lift the handset or press the [MON] button then intercom dial tone will be heard.
2. Dial 5 6 9 (UNA code).
3. The call is connected.
Condition
1. UNA feature is activated when the Ring Mode is night.
2. If there’s no ringing CO Call when the station dialed Night Answer Code, error tone will be heard.
3. The connected CO Line may be transferred or disconnected in the usual manner.
4. If External Night Ringing is set to On, the call is routed to External Page (see Ref.3) by LBC1(see
Ref.4).
Reference
1. Night Answer Code : 3.2.7
2. Ring Mode : 2.13.8
3. External Page : 4.11.2.7
4. LBC : 4.4.9.1
Admin Programming
UNA 4.2.2.8 (PGM 141 – FLEX 8)
External Night Ring 4.4.1.7 (PGM 160 – FLEX 7)
20
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
Each station is allowed or denied to access particular CO Lines or CO Groups. Station user may use
flexible buttons which are assigned as a {CO} button or {CO Group} button including {POOL} button
and {LOOP} button. By Numbering Plan, station users can access individual CO Lines by dialing CO
Access codes.
Figure 2.2.1 describes to access CO Lines by dialing CO Access codes( 9 or 0, depend on a nation ).
By dialing 9 (see Ref.1), the user can seize the first idle line among CO groups permitted to access
(see Ref.4). And if Dial 8801 (see Ref.2), the user can seize the CO Line 001 if it is idle. Or, by dialing
801 (see Ref.3), the user can seize the first idle CO Line among CO Group 1.
IP LDK System
9 4501234
8801
4501234
PSTN
81
4501234
4501234
Operation
CO Line Access
To access a CO Line from a DKTU,
1. Lift the Handset or press the [MON] button.
2. Press the desired CO Line, {POOL} button, or {LOOP} button.
3. Or, dial the individual CO Line access code, CO group access code, or the first CO Line access
code from the accessible group.
21
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
1. A DKTU should have an idle appearance (CO Line/Pool button/Loop button) to access an
outgoing CO Line/incoming CO Line.
2. To assign the {LOOP} button,
[TRANS/PGM] + {FLEX} + [TRANS/PGM] + 8 4 + [HOLD/SAVE]
3. When the Override 1st CO Line Group is enabled, the system will search for the next accessible
CO group until a CO Line is available if there is no available CO Line by dialing CO Line group
access code (‘9’ or ‘0’).
4. A station which is not permitted to access a CO Line will hear error while trying to access a CO
Line, but the station can receive a transferred CO Line call.
5. The CO Line choice (Round-robin or Last Choice) is determined by Admin Programming
(ADMIN 160-FLEX 3)
6. If the CO Line is BRI, when a user tries to seize B1 but the network requests to serve B2, the
system can change CO Line to B2. (There is a {B2 CO} button or {LOOP} button.)
7. Unused CO Lines should be assigned to unused CO group 9 to prevent to be accessed by a
station.
8. The first CO Line group (00) is directed line group and it can be used with {CO Line} button
(Private Line).
Reference
1. Access CO in 1st CO Group Code : 3.2.7 (PGM 107 – FLEX 12)
2. Access Individual CO Code : 3.2.7 (PGM 107 – FLEX 8)
3. Access CO Group Code : 3.2.7 (PGM 107 – FLEX 7)
4. CO Group Access : 4.1.8
Admin Programming
CO Line Choice 4.4.1.3 (PGM 160 – FLEX 3)
Inter-digit Timer 4.5.2.8 (PGM 181 – FLEX 8)
CO Line Group Access 4.1.8 (PGM 117)
CO Line Group 4.2.2.1 (PGM 141 – FLEX 1)
Override 1st CO Line Group 4.4.2.3 (PGM 161 – FLEX 3)
22
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
This feature is used to restrict an outgoing CO call time. In a station programming, user set the CO
Call Drop Timer, the call will be disconnected automatically when the timer is expired. The caller and
called parties will hear warning tone 15sec before the CO call is disconnected.
Condition
1. This feature can be assigned on a station base.
2. It is applied to just outgoing CO call.
3. If the CO Call Drop timer enabled in a station, the timer is still applied even a call is transferred to
another station.
4. On the add-on conference, the CO Call Drop timer enabled station will be restricted to the
outgoing CO call time.
5. The CO Call Drop timer is not released even the caller holds, transfers, or flashes the CO Line.
Admin Programming
CO Call Time Restriction 4.1.3.3 (PGM 112 – FLEX 3)
CO Call Restriction Timer 4.5.1.17 (PGM 180 – FLEX 17)
23
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
When station user receives a busy tone during an attempt to access a CO Line, the user may request
a call back(queue). The station will receive a call back when the busy CO Line becomes available.
Operation
To activate queuing while receiving busy tone,
1. Press and release hook-switch if the station is SLT.
2. Dial 5 5 6(see Ref.1) or press [CALL BK] button.
3. Confirmation tone is heard and then replace the handset.
4. When the CO Line becomes idle, callback ring is received at the station. On Lifting handset, CO
dial tone is heard to make a call.
Condition
1. A CO Line may have any number of queues at one time.
2. When the queued CO Line becomes idle or a CO Line becomes available in the group, the oldest
queued station will receive signal.
3. A station can make only one CO Line queuing request at one time. If the station tries to make
another CO Line queuing, the previous one is canceled and the later one is available.
4. If the waiting station is busy and the queued CO Line is available, the available CO Line will be
directed to the next station which is idle.
5. If the waiting station is idle, the queued CO Line will give signal to the station for 15 seconds. If the
signal is not received at the station, the queue is canceled and the next station in the queue will
receive signal.
Reference
1. Message Wait Enable Code : 3.4.3
Admin Programming
CO Line Queuing 4.1.3.5 (PGM 112 – FLEX 5)
24
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
When a station receives a busy tone after accessing a CO Line, the user can dial a CO Line number
which has the same first digits as the called busy CO Line without dialing the full number.
Operation
To use CO Step Call when receiving busy tone, press the [SPEED] button and dial the last 1 digit.
Then the previous call is terminated and new call is established.
Description
The user can dial the emergency service code regardless of lower station COS.
Condition
1. An emergency call can be dialed by pressing CO Line though the station which is assigned to COS
7.
2. If the dialed number for emergency code is the same with station number or LCR number, the call
is operated as an emergency call. The preference of programmed dial number which is sent to
external CO Line is, Emergency Call code → LCR Table → Station Number.
Admin Programming
Emergency Call 4.10.3.1 (PGM 226)
25
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
A station user can make an outgoing call by only going off-hook, if the user has previously stored the
destination.
The following figure 2.2.2 describes Hot Line / Warm Line operation. The destination can be CO Line
/ CO Line Group, the function which is set at Flexible button, or another station.
Hot Line can be activated immediately upon an off-hook, Warm Line can be activated after Warm
Line Timer expired. If the user dial other number within Warm Line Time, the call activates as normal
call, not as Warm Line call.
Flexible Flexible
Enter Dial
Button No Digit Button
(Warm Line Time)
Station
Station
Normal Call
Operation
To activate Hot Line,
1. Lift the handset at a station, which is assigned to Hot Line.
2. The assigned hot line feature is activated immediately.
Condition
1. A station can be assigned to Hot line or Warm line by Admin Programming (ADMIN 113-FLEX 7).
2. If there is no flexible button in a station, the number is operated as speed dial number.
3. The setting value of Warm Line timer should be less than that of Dial Tone timer.
4. A flexible button may be assigned as {Idle Line Selection} button. When lifting handset or pressing
the [MON] button, the system will be activated as a predefined button is pressed.
5. It is possible to activate in SLT station.
Admin Programming
Warm Line Timer 4.5.3.8 (PGM 182 – FLEX 8)
Warm Line 4.1.4.7 (PGM 113 – FLEX 7)
Idle Line Selection 4.1.13 (PGM 122)
26
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
LCR is a system programmable feature that is automatically selected the least expensive available
route when an outgoing CO call is made. This programming eliminates the necessity for the user to
dial the access code of the least expensive carrier. There are three types of operation to activate LCR;
Internal LCR - It can be activated during internal dial tone. If the dialed digits are matched with
internal LCR code, the system will seize a CO Line from the programmed CO group and send the
modified digits according to LCR programming.
Loop LCR - It can be activated by dialing the first accessible CO group code ('9' or '0') or by pressing
Loop button. If the dialed digits are matched with COL LCR code, the system will seize a CO Line
from the programmed CO group and send the modified digits according to LCR programming.
Direct CO LCR - It can be activated during CO dial tone. After dialing CO Line or CO group code( 9 or
0, depend on nation), or pressing CO Line or CO group button, it can be activated. If the dialed digits
are matched with COL LCR code, the system will seize a CO Line from the programmed CO group
and send the modified digits according to LCR programming.
Network A
IP LDK System 001
002
Network B
Network
Caller dials ‘9’
and phone no 008
(850 1234)
Network C
(850 1234)
27
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Operation
Internal LCR
1. Dial internal LCR code after lifting handset or pressing the [MON] button. On-hook dialing can
also activate LCR call.
2. It is an internal LCR code if the code is programmed with internal or both in Leading Digit Table.
Loop LCR
1. Dial COL LCR code after dialing the first accessible CO Line or CO group access code ('0' or '9')
or press the Loop button.
2. It is a COL LCR code if the code is programmed with COL or BOTH in Leading Digit Table.
Direct CO LCR
1. Dial COL LCR code after dialing CO or CO group access code or pressing CO or CO group button.
2. It is a COL LCR code if the code is programmed with COL or BOTH in Leading Digit Table.
Flow Chart
User off-hook
& Hear internal dial-tone
NO
Is dialed digit matched
with LDT? (INT/BOTH)
YES
YES
Internal LCR
28
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
User off-hook
& Hear internal dial-tone
Press CO access code Press CO Button
or LOOP key or LOOP key when LCR Mode : M13
(LOOP LCR) (CO LCR)
Is dialed digit NO NO
Is dialed digit
matched with LDT? matched with LDT?
(COL/BOTH) (COL/BOTH)
YES
YES
Choose CO group & Choose available CO Send modified digit using Send dialed digit
send modified digit using group & send dialed digit DMT
DMT
29
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
1. There are 6 LCR modes. The mode is determined by ADMIN 220 – FLEX 1.
- LCR Access Mode 00 (M00): LCR call is disabled.
- LCR Access Mode 01 (M01): Only Loop LCR is activated.
- LCR Access Mode 02 (M02): Internal LCR and Loop LCR are activated.
- LCR Access Mode 11 (M11): Loop LCR and CO LCR are activated.
- LCR Access Mode 12 (M12): All types of LCR are activated.
(When dialing ‘9’ or pressing Loop key, the system will wait next digits to compare LCR table
without seizing CO Line.)
- LCR Access Mode 13 (M13): All types of LCR are activated.
(When dial ‘9’ or press Loop key, the system will seize the first available CO Line and wait next
digits to compare LCR table.)
2. The leading digits can be duplicated. FLEX 2 and DMT index make each entry unique.
3. Leading digit table is sorted by leading digits, FLEX 2 in LDT (INT, COL, BOTH) and DMT index.
4. Internal LCR is applied if the dialed digits are matched with one of leading digits and FLEX 2 is INT
or BOTH.
5. Loop LCR is applied if the dialed digits are matched with one of leading digits and FLEX 2 is COL
or BOTH.
6. Direct CO LCR is applied if the dialed digits are matched with one of leading digits and FLEX 2 is
COL or BOTH and the seized CO Line belongs to the programmed CO group in DMT.
7. To work Loop LCR and Direct CO LCR differently with the same leading digits, there should be the
leading digit entry for loop LCR prior to the leading digits for direct CO LCR. It is possible if the
DMT index for loop LCR is smaller than the DMT index for direct CO LCR.
8. While direct CO LCR is applied to ISDN CO, an ISDN Information message with called party IE,
which includes only numbering plan and numbering type, is sent to the network when a user dials
a digit. It is for the network not to disconnect the line.
9. For direct CO LCR, leading digits should be programmed in consideration for the dial tone time
provided by network.
10. Direct CO LCR does not use an alternative DMT index because a CO Line is already seized.
11. LCR always has the higher precedence than flexible numbering plan table.
12. LCR can be applied to the following cases;
- Dialing after seizing CO Line by dialing CO Line access code (0 or 9) only
- Dialing after seizing CO Line by {LOOP} button
- Dialing without seizing CO Line
- Speed Dial
- Off-net Call Forward
- Redial (if the previous call is LCR applied)
- ACNR (If the call is LCR applied when activating ACNR)
13. Any leading digit string at the LDT table can be sub-string another leading digit string as ‘012’ and
‘0123’.
14. Capacity for LCR Table:
- 3 Day Zones
- 3 Time Zones
- Number of ‘Dialed Code Bins’: 250 bins
- Number of ‘Modification Code Bins’: 100 bins
- Maximum number of ‘Dialed digits’: 12 digits
- Maximum number of ‘Added digits’: 25 digits
- Alternative DMT index: 1EA
30
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Admin Programming
LCR Attributes 4.9.1 (PGM 220)
LCR – LDT Table 4.9.2 (PGM 221)
LCR – DMT Table 4.9.3 (PGM 222)
LCR Table Initialization 4.9.4 (PGM 223)
31
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
ADMIN 106
remove / change numbering plan which starts with ‘7’
32
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
If Call destination is busy or no answer, Redialing is operated repeatedly within ACNR retry counter.
The system will retry the number based on programming with appropriate pauses in between dialing.
(default: 3 times)
Operation
To use ACNR while receiving busy/no answer on a CO Line,
1. Press the [REDIAL] button.
2. Replace the handset or go on-hook.
3. The system will automatically retry the call at programmed intervals.
4. When the called party answers, lift handset or press [MUTE] button to make the call.
To cancel,
Press the flashing [REDIAL] button. Or, Lift handset or press [MUTE] button while a CO Line is
seized to make ACNR.
Condition
1. A DKTU which doesn't have [REDIAL] button, should be programmed with a [REDIAL] Flexible
Button to use ACNR.
[TRANS/PGM] + Flex. FLEX + [TRANS/PGM] + 9 7 + [HOLD/SAVE] (2/8 Button only)
2. The analog CO Lines in the system should be equipped with Call Progress Tone detection Units
(CPTU).
3. When predefined CO Line is busy in ACNR mode, an available CO Line in the same group will be
seized.
Admin Programming
ACNR Pause Timer 4.5.1.10 (PGM 180 – FLEX 10)
ACNR Delay Timer 4.5.1.8 (PGM 180 – FLEX 8)
ACNR Tone Detect Timer 4.5.1.13 (PGM 180 – FLEX 13) – applicable to analog CO Line only
ACNR No Answer Timer 4.5.1.9 (PGM 180 – FLEX 9)
ACNR Retry Counter 4.5.1.11 (PGM 180 – FLEX 11)
ACNR Tone Cadence (PGM 423)
33
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
The last dialed number with CO Line can be stored (up to 48 digits) in the station's Last Number
Redial buffer. The user may request the system redial the last number without redialing the full number.
Each DKTU with LCD in the system has 10 individual last dialed number directory.
Operation
To use Last Number Redial at DKTU,
1. Lift the handset or press the [MON] button.
2. Press the [REDIAL] button. Or, press the [SPEED] button and dial *.
3. Press [HOLD/SAVE] button.
To use one of dialed number in the Last Number Directory by scrolling at DKTU with LCD),
1. When last dialed number is displayed, press [UP] or [DOWN] button to find a phone number.
(Max. 10 last dialed number can be stored in the directory.)
2. To make a call, press [HOLD/SAVE] button when the phone number is displayed.
Condition
1. When the used CO Line is busy, an idle CO Line in the group is seized and the last dialed
number is dialed.
2. The last dialed number directory allows a duplicated phone number.
3. If you use Last Number Redial while the Auto-redial is activated, the auto-redial is canceled.
Reference
1. SLT Last Speed Dial Code : 3.2.7 (PGM 106 – FLEX 12)
Description
Any dialed number can be saved temporarily and used at any time. This number is saved until a new
number is stored
Operation
To save a number in the Save Number Redial buffer from a DKTU,
1. Press the [SPEED] button twice, while conversation with external party.
2. Replace the handset and go on-hook.
34
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
To dial a number from the Save Number Redial buffer from a DKTU,
1. Lift the handset or press the [MON] button.
2. Press the [SPEED] button.
3. Dial # button.
Condition
1. When the used CO Line is busy, an idle CO Line in the group is seized and the saved number is
dialed.
2. The stored save number is not deleted at when the system power is off.
3. If you press [SPEED] button twice after seizing a CO Line with dialing and go idle state, the save
number redial bin will be erased.
Description
A DKTU user can store frequently used station number to station Speed Bin(000~099) up to 100.
Station numbers are saved up to 24 digits including pauses, Flash commands, pulse-to-tone
switchover, and no-display characters. A pause is automatically inserted after a flash. The station
speed bin numbers of IP LDK-20 is 500.
Operation
To make a call using Station Speed Dial from a DKTU,
1. Lift the handset or press the [MON] button.
2. Press the [SPEED] button.
3. Dial the station speed dial bin (000~099).
35
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
1. CPTU should be installed to detect dial tone.
2. The Station Speed Dial is secured in data protect mode when the power is off.
3. There can be max. 24 digits in a station speed dial number including some digits and special
function codes.
4. If you dial an empty station speed bin, error tone will be heard.
5. If you select a CO Line before dialing speed bin number, the selected CO Line is used though
there is programmed CO Line in the speed bin number.
6. You can program a station name (max. 7 characters) in the DKTU to be presented instead of
station number. The name is programmed in the speed bin 000. When the station name is
programmed, the speed bin is not used as a station speed bin.
Reference
1. CO Dial Tone Detect : 4.4.1.6 (ADMIN 160 – FLEX 6)
2. Speed Dial program code 3.2.7 (ADMIN 106 – FLEX 15)
3. Speed Dial access code 3.2.7 (ADMIN 106 – FLEX 18)
36
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Admin Programming
Speed Dial Access 4.1.3.9 (PGM 112 - FLEX 9)
CO Dial Tone Detect 4.4.1.6 (PGM 160 – FLEX 6)
Description
The system speed dial bins are programmed by system attendant. These numbers are available for
easy access by all stations allowed in the system. Max. system speed dial capacity is 500 in IP LDK-20.
[Flow chart]
Registration Station
Speed Dial
Attendant
2000~2199 Restricted by
Station COS
CO Outgoing
Station COS
COS 1 There is no restriction to dial.
COS 2 Monitored by Exception Table A
COS 3 Monitored by Exception Table B
COS 4 Monitored by Exception Table A & B
COS 5 Long distance call is not allowed. (The dialed digits can be longer than 7 digits.)
COS 6 Long distance call is not allowed. Only max. 7 digits may be dialed.
COS 7 Only intercom, paging and emergency call are allowed. No dialing allowed on CO Lines.
37
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Operation
To store a number in a System Speed Dial from the system attendant,
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Press the [SPEED] button.
3. Dial the system speed dial bin.
4. If desired, press the CO Line or Group button.
5. Dial the desired phone number and include these special codes.(max. 24 digits)
[CALLBK] – Insert Pause
‘*’ – Display Security.
If it is stored as the first digit, its function is Display Security. Otherwise, its function is Pulse to
DTMF Switchover.
[DND/FOR] – If CO Dial Tone Detect (see Ref.1) is set to ON and it is stored as the first or second
digit and the seized CO Line is behind PBX mode, its function is Dial Tone Detect. Otherwise,
its function is ‘*’.
[FLASH] – Inserts a Flash into the speed number.
If seized CO Line is analog line, its function is Flash to PX (or PBX). If seized CO Line is
ISDN(2.14) line and it is stored as the first digit, it makes remaining digits sent with enveloped
not in calling party number IE but in keypad facility IE
6. Press the [HOLD/SAVE] button.
7. If desired, enter the name (Max. 12 characters) by dialing 2-digit for each character.
8. Press the [HOLD/SAVE] button.
* Note: To store continuously, repeat the above procedure from 3.
Condition
1. The CPTU should be installed for dial tone detect.
2. System Speed Dial is restricted by Station COS.
3. There can be max. 24 digits in a system speed dial number including some digits and special
function codes.
4. If you dial an empty system speed bin, error tone will be heard.
5. If you select a CO Line before dialing system speed bin number, the selected CO Line is used
though there is programmed CO Line in the system speed bin number.
6. If all CO Lines in the group are busy, busy tone will be received when accessing a system speed
number.
7. System Speed numbers are protected when the system power is off.
38
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Reference
1. CO Dial Tone Detect : 4.4.1.6 (ADMIN 160 – FLEX 6)
2. Speed Dial access code 3.2.7 (ADMIN 106 – FLEX 18)
Admin Programming
Speed Dial Access 4.1.3.9 (PGM 112 – FLEX 9)
System Speed Zone Access 4.11.5 (PGM 232)
CO Dial Tone Detect 4.4.1.6 (PGM 160 - FLEX 6)
Description
CO Lines in the system can be assigned for exclusive use by one or more DKTU users. Private lines
are assigned to CO Line Group 00 and an appearance (Flexible CO button) is required at the DKTU.
(Loop or Pool keys cannot be used.)
Operation
A private line will operate as a normal CO Line except access is limited to assigned stations.
Condition
1. Private line cannot be picked up.
Admin Programming
CO Line Group 4.2.2.1 (PGM 141 – FLEX 1)
39
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
A station user can forward calls to any station, station group or VMIB in the system, by activating
feature codes. Figure 2.3.1 Describes destination types of Call Forwarding. Each Call forwarding is
decided by Call Forward type.
[Forward Type]
Station off-net Forward Unconditional Forward
Busy
STA A No Answer STA B
Busy / No Answer
Forward
VMIB Announcement
Hunt Group
Call forward
Condition
1. To use Call Forward, a station should be permitted at ADMIN programming.
2. There’re several types of call forwarding ; Unconditional, Busy, No Answer, Busy/No Answer,
Unconditional Station Off-net Call Forward, No Answer Station Off-net Call Forward, Incoming CO
Off-net Call Forward and Follow Me Call Forward.
3. To deactivating Call Forward, set call forward type # which means to remove call forward setting.
Admin Programming
Allow Off-net FWD 4.1.2.18 (PGM 111 – FLEX 18)
Authorization Code Table 4.11.1 (PGM 227)
40
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
A user forwards all calls immediately to other station, Hunt Group or VMIB.
Operation
To activate Unconditional Call Forward,
1. Lift the Handset or press the [MON] button.
2. Press the [DND/FOR] button.
3. Dial Call Forward Code 1.
4. Dial station or group pilot number to receive the calls.
5. Replace the handset and go on-hook.
41
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Operation
To make call forward,
1. Lift the handset or press the [MON] button.
2. Press the [DND/FOR] button.
3. Dial a Call Forward type code: 2
4. Dial station, group number or # (VMIB) to receive the call.
42
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
When the station user does not answer within a predetermined timer
(Call Forward No Answer Timer 4.5.2.1 (ADMIN 181 – FLEX 1)
Operation
To make call forward,
1. Lift the handset or press the [MON] button.
2. Press the [DND/FOR] button.
3. Dial a Call Forward type code: 3
4. Dial station, group number or VMIB number to receive the call.
43
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
A user can direct the system to re-route call to other station, group or VMIB when the user's station is
busy and/or does not answer in a predefined 'No Answer' time. Incoming CO Line, transferred CO Line
and ringing Intercom calls are forwarded.
Operation
To make call forward,
1. Lift the handset or press the [MON] button.
2. Press the [DND/FOR] button.
3. Dial a Call Forward type code: 4
4. Dial station, group number or VMIB number to receive the call.
44
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
Stations allowed call forward access can forward intercom and transferred CO Line calls to a directory
number (telephone number) outside of the system. When a call is received, the system will access an
outgoing CO Line and dial the telephone number entered by the user.
If a station assigned off-net call forward received a call from internal caller and external caller, the call
is forwarded to off-net unconditionally (Code 5) or after No Answer Ring timer is expired (Code 6).
Operation
To activate unconditional Off-Net Call Forward,
1. Lift the handset or press the [MON] button.
2. Press the [DND/FOR] button.
3. Dial Call Forward Code 5.
4. Seize a CO Line, if required.
5. Dial the Speed Dial bin number with the desired phone number.
6. Replace the handset and go on-hook.
45
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
The system attendant can direct the system to re-route(forward) incoming CO Line calls to a directory
(telephone) number outside the system. When a call is received, the system will access an outgoing
CO Line and dial the telephone number assigned by the attendant. Note that the system will
automatically disconnect the call after the Unsupervised Conference Timer has expired.
Operation
To activate Follow-me Call Forward from any station,
1. Lift the handset or press the [MON] button.
2. Press the [DND/FOR] button.
3. Dial Call Forward code ‘7’.
4. Dial CO Line/group access code (9, 801-8xx, 8801-88xx, or 8* for all CO Lines) or press {CO
Line} button.
5. Dial the Speed Dial bin number with the desired telephone number.
6. Replace the Handset and go on-hook.
Condition
1. If there is no idle CO Line, Off-net Call Forward is not activated.
2. This feature is not applicable for DID line.
3. It is unconditional and forwarded immediately when the CO Line rings in the system.
4. If a speed bin is programmed in a Flexible button, you may press the Flexible button instead of
dialing the speed bin number.
5. Toll restriction will be based on the COS of outgoing CO Line. But, it doesn’t care CO authorization
code.
46
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
Follow-Me Call Forward can be activated at the user's station or from any other station in the system
allowed access to Call Forward. It must be programmed from the station that you will be forwarded to
and a user password must be entered at the user's station first.
Operation
To activate Follow-me Call Forward from any station,
1. Lift the Handset or press the [MON] button.
2. Press the [DND/FOR] button.
3. Dial Call Forward Code ‘0’.
4. Dial forwarding station number.
5. Dial forwarding station authorization code.
6. Replace the Handset and go on-hook.
Condition
1. Authorization code should be registered to use Follow-me Call Forward.
Admin Programming
Allow Off-net FWD 4.1.2.18 (PGM 111 – FLEX 18)
Authorization Code Table 4.11.1 (PGM 227)
Call Forward 4.1.2.2 (PGM 111 – FLEX 2)
Call Forward No Answer Timer 4.5.2.1 (PGM 181 – FLEX 1)
Off-net Call Mode 4.1.3.12 (PGM 112 – FLEX 12)
Unsupervised Conference Timer 4.5.3.6 (PGM 182 – FLEX 6)
47
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
A user of single line telephone can forward a call to other stations, CO Lines or VMIB in the system.
Operation
To activate call forward from a SLT,
1. Lift the handset.
2. Dial call forward code 5 5 4 (see Ref.1).
3. Dial call forward type.
4. Dial station number or Group speed number to receive call. Or, press # key to forward to VMIB.
5. Replace the handset and go on-hook.
Condition
1. Call forward is maintained until it is released.
2. A call cannot be forwarded to a station which is in DND. When trying to forward to the station, error
tone will be heard.
3. A call forwarding station cannot make a message wait.
4. The call forward feature may be canceled by code 5 5 9. It is unified cancel code for DND/Call
Forward/Message for SLT.
5. Dial pulse SLT cannot be forwarded to VMIB.
Reference
1. Call forward Code : 3.2.7 (ADMIN 106 – FLEX 14)
2. DND/FWD Cancel Code : 3.2.7 (ADMIN 106 – FLEX 19)
Admin Programming
Call Forward 4.1.2.2 (PGM 111 – FLEX 2)
VMIB Access 4.1.4.2 (PGM 113 – FLEX 2)
48
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
When a station receives incoming CO Call and the station is programmed to Preset Call Forward, the
call is routed to Preset Call Forward destination if the station does not answer within Preset Call
Forward Timer.
The destination can be other station or hunt group.
Condition
1. In Preset Call Forward, a busy station will not receive a CO Line ring and the next assigned
station will receive the CO Line ring. If the station is not forwarded to other destination, then the
call will not be forwarded and continue to ring at the station until answered.
2. The loop of Preset Call Forward is not available. (A→B→ C→ A)
3. When a CO Line is forwarded with Preset Call Forward, the original station will stop ringing. (The
LED of {CO } button will be flashing continuously.)
4. If there is no direct {CO} button or {LOOP} button at destination station, the station will be
bypassed.
Admin Programming
Preset Call Forward 4.1.12 (PGM 121)
Preset Call Forward Timer 4.5.2.12 (PGM 181 – FLEX 12)
Description
DID calls can be rerouted by no answer forward/CCR.. In this case, if rereouted destination is
busy/noans/error case, calls follows by second reroute destation(PGM 167-Flexible button5,6,7)
Condition
1. This feature is only for UK.
49
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
An Intercom Call or CO Call can be transferred to other station or CO Line during conversation.
There are 2 kinds of call transfer ; Screened Transfer and Unscreened Transfer.
If the transferring user(originator) makes a conversation with transferred-to user(destination) before
Call Transfer completed, it is Screened Transfer. Otherwise if the transferring user replaces the
handset while listening ring back tone just after dialing transferred-to destination, it is Unscreened
Transfer.
Call Transfer
50
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
A station user may transfer connected Call to new CO Call. If an external party on ISDN does not
answer the transferred call within Transfer Hold Recall time, the transferring station will receive recall
ring. If the call remains unanswered, the attendant will receive recall ring for Attendant Recall time.
After that, the CO Line will be disconnected and returned to idle state.
Operation
Unscreened CO Line Call Transfer;
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Intercom dial tone is heard and the previous call is placed on hold.
3. Seize a CO Line and dial the number of external party to receive the call.
4. Replace the handset and go on-hook.
Condition
1. For this feature, CO Lines (transferred CO Line and transferring CO Line) must be able to detect
loop lost or disconnection condition.
2. If the transferred CO Line doesn’t have answer information (analog CO), recalling will not be
presented when it is not answered. And, the call will be disconnected after Unsupervised
Conference timer.
3. If the transferred line is ISDN CO, recall ring will be presented to the CO Line after Transfer Hold
Recall time while the line is released.
4. If you press the original incoming CO Line button while making transfer to an external number
(Screened Transfer), the outgoing call is disconnected and the original incoming call is connected.
Admin Programming
Transfer Recall Timer 4.5.1.7 (PGM 180 – FLEX 7)
I-Hold Recall Timer 4.5.1.5 (PGM 180 – FLEX 5)
Attendant Recall Timer 4.5.1.1 (PGM 180 – FLEX 1)
Open Loop Detect Timer 4.2.3.13 (PGM N 142 – FLEX 13)
Unsupervised Conference timer 4.5.3.6(PGM 182 – FLEX 6)
51
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
A Call can be transferred to another station within the system. The transfer can be
screened(announced) or unscreened to an idle/busy station or Hunt Group. The transferred call rings
and provides Exclusive Hold flashing indication to the receiving party’s DKTU.
If the receiving station does not answer the call in the Transfer Recall time, the transferring station and
the transferred station will receive recall. If the call still remains unanswered, the attendant will also
receive a recall for the Attendant Recall time. After that, the transferred call will be disconnected.
Operation
To transfer to an idle station,
To make an unscreened transfer,
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Intercom dial tone is heard and the previous call is placed on exclusive hold.
3. Dial the station number to receive the transfer.
4. Replace the handset or go on-hook.
52
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
1. When the attendant has a DSS and a station of programmed in DSS receives transferred call, the
LED of DSS button in attendant will flashing.
2. When the SLT user is in the screened transfer mode and tries to converse both transferred station
and CO Line, the user can activate brokers call with hook-flash.
3. It is impossible to transfer a call to another busy SLT from a SLT. When receiving busy tone, SLT
user can be connected to the CO Line with hook-flash.
Admin Programming
Transfer Recall Timer 4.5.1.7 (PGM 180 – FLEX 7)
I-Hold Recall Timer 4.5.1.5 (PGM 180 – FLEX 5)
Attendant Recall Timer 4.5.1.1 (PGM 180 – FLEX 1)
No Touch Answer 4.1.2.7 (PGM 111 – FLEX 7)
53
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
A station user can hold a call. The following features are available depending on the result.
Feature Description
Any Station can retrieve a held call.
System Hold
Other station in the group can seize the CO Line and answer.
Only the station user who held the call can retrieve it.
Exclusive Hold
Other station in the group cannot seize the CO Line.
2.3.3.1 Hold
Description
There are 2 kinds of Hold ; System Hold and Exclusive Hold.
If a Call is held by System hold, the call may be retrieved by any station. Otherwise if it is held by
Exclusive Hold, only the station who has held the call can retrieve.
Operation
To make a CO Line on Exclusive/System Hold from a DKTU,
Press the [HOLD/SAVE] button once or twice. (It depends on Hold Preference.)
Condition
1. The CO Line placed on Exclusive Hold will flash in the station and the LED of CO Line will light in
other stations.
2. The CO Line placed on System Hold will flash in all stations.
3. When Exclusive Hold is set in a station, Exclusive Hold Recall Timer is initiated. After Exclusive
Hold Recall Timer is expired, the original station will receive recall for I-Hold Recall Timer. Also,
When System Hold is set in a station, System Hold Recall Timer is initiated. After System Hold
Recall Timer is expired, the original station will receive recall for I-Recall Timer.
4. When the I-Hold Recall Timer is expired, attendant will also receive a recall for Attendant Recall
54
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Timer. If the call remains unanswered for Attendant Recall time, the call is disconnected.
Reference
1. System Hold Code : 3.2.7 (ADMIN106 – FLEX 20)
2. Held Individual CO Line Code : 3.2.7 (ADMIN107 – FLEX 11)
3. Access Held CO Group Code : 3.2.7 (ADMIN107 – FLEX 10)
Admin Programming
Hold Preference 4.4.1.8 (PGM 160 – FLEX 8)
Attendant Recall Timer 4.5.1.1 (PGM 180 – FLEX 1)
Exclusive Hold Recall Timer 4.5.1.4 (PGM 180 – FLEX 4)
I-Hold Recall Timer 4.5.1.5 (PGM 180 – FLEX 5)
System Hold Recall Timer 4.5.1.6 (PGM 180 – FLEX 6)
Transfer Recall Timer 4.5.1.7 (PGM 180 – FLEX 7)
Description
Preferred Hold type is set by ADMIN programming. When user presses [HOLD] button, the preferred
type of Hold is activated. If the user presses [HOLD] button twice, the other type is activated.
That is, if System Hold is set as preferred Hold and the user held the call by pressing [HOLD] button
once, the call can be retrieved by any user who access the held call. Otherwise System Hold is set as
preferred hold and the original user held the call by pressing [HOLD] button twice, the hold type is
Exclusive at this time and other users are not permitted to access the held call.
Operation
1. If System Hold is set as preferred Hold and the user presses the held the [HOLD] button once, the
call is held by System Hold (Ref.1).
2. If System Hold is set as preferred Hold and the user presses the held the [HOLD] button twice, the
call is held by Exclusive Hold (Ref.1).
3. When the Exclusive Hold is assigned, other station in the group cannot seize the held call.
4. When the System Hold is assigned, other station in the group can seize the held call and answer.
Reference
1. System Hold / Exclusive Hold : 2.3.3
Admin Programming
Hold Preference 4.4.1.8 (PGM 160 – FLEX 8)
55
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
When a station is connected to a CO Call, the station user can make another intercom call just by
pressing DSS button. In this case, the previous CO Call is held automatically.
It is also able to applied to CO Call to CO Call. That is, when a station user makes another CO call by
pressing {CO} button without disconnecting previous CO Call, the previous Call is holed by Auto Hold
ADMIN programming. The held CO line follows preferred hold type by ADMIN programming.
Operation
To use Automatic Hold while on a CO Line call,
1. Press a {CO} button.
2. When the new CO Line is connected, the previous CO Call is placed on preferred hold state.
Admin Programming
Automatic Hold 4.1.3.2 (PGM 112 – FLEX 2)
Hold Preference 4.4.1.8 (PGM 160 – FLEX 8)
2.3.3.4 Park
Description
A user can park a call in a virtual location. The user may make a page announcement for the desired
user to pick-up the parked call. The call retrieve the call by dialing the location number. If the station
neither have the {CO} button nor {LOOP} button, the user cannot retrieve.
If the call remains unanswered for the Call Park Recall time, the original station which parking the call
receives recall. If the call is still unanswered, then the attendant will receive recall at this time. If
attendant doesn’t answer again in the Attendant Recall time, the CO Line call will be disconnected and
returned to idle.
Operation
To park a call,
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Dial the parking location 601~608(Call Park Location Code (Ref.1)).
3. Replace the handset or go on-hook
4. If desired, page to the desired user to retrieve the call.
Condition
1.To receive the parked call, the station should have {CO} button or {LOOP} button.
56
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Reference
1. Call Park Location Code : 3.4 (ADMIN107 – FLEX 5)
Admin Programming
Call Park Recall Timer 4.5.1.2 (PGM 180 – FLEX 2)
2.3.4 Pickup
Description
A station user can pick up other station’s call.
In intercom Calls, incoming CO Calls, recalling CO Calls and transferred CO Calls can be picked up
instead of the ringing station.
Reference
1. Intercom Tenancy Group : 2.5.15 (ADMIN120)
2. Pick up Attribute : 4.7.1.2
Description
A station can pick up a call ringing other station by dialing the direct call pick up code (Ref.1) and the
ringing station number.
Operation
To answer a call ringing at another station,
1. Lift the handset or press the [MON] button.
2. Dial Direct Call Pick-up code 7 (Ref. 1). Or, press {Direct Call Pick-up} button.
3. Dial the intercom number of the ringing station.
Condition
1. To assign {DIRECT CALL PICK-UP} button at a flexible button,
57
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Reference
1. Intercom Tenancy Group : 2.5.15 (ADMIN120)
2. Pick up Attribute : 4.7.1.2
3. Direct Call Pick up Code : 3.2.7 (ADMIN107 – FLEX 6)
Admin Programming
PLA Priority Setting 4.4.14 (PGM 173) - Pick-up Priority
Description
A station can pick up a call ringing at other station in the same pick-up group. Ringing intercom calls,
incoming CO Lines, recalling CO Lines and transferred CO Lines can be answered by a station
instead of the ringing station if the stations belong to the same pick-up group (Ref.1).
Operation
To answer a call ringing at a station in your Pick-up group,
1. Lift the handset or press the [MON] button.
2. Dial Group Pick-up code 5 6 6 (Ref.2).
Condition
1. To assign {GROUP CALL PICK-UP} button at a flexible button,
[TRANS/PGM] + FLEX + 5 6 6 (Ref.2) + [HOLD/SAVE]
2. An intercom call to ‘H’ or ‘P’ mode station cannot be picked up.
3. You should have {CO Line} button, {LOOP} or {POOL} button to pick-up a CO Line call.
4. Queued callback and private line cannot be picked up.
5. A station can answer an intercom call placed to an ICM box using group call pick-up.
6. When several calls are queued at a station or hunt group, the pick-up depends on the Pick-up
Priority (ADMIN 173).
7. When the same type of CO Lines are queued, the first queued CO Line is picked up.
8. Group call pick-up is allowed within the intercom tenancy group. A station cannot pick up any call to
the station which belongs to denied intercom tenancy group (Ref.3).
Reference
58
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Admin Programming
Pick-up Attribute 4.7.1.2 (PGM 190 – FLEX 2)
Pick-up Group Attributes 4.7.2.5 (PGM 191)
PLA Priority Setting 4.4.14 (PGM 173) - Pick-up Priority
Operation
To program Custom Message 00 from a station,
Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
1. Dial 5 2. (see Ref.2)
2. Enter the message (see Figure 2.4.1).
3. The message can be entered up to 24 characters.
4. Press the [HOLD/SAVE] button and confirmation tone is heard.
Q – 11 A - 21 D - 31
Z – 12 B - 22 E - 32
. – 13 C - 23 F - 33
1 – 10 2 - 20 3 - 30
G – 41 J - 51 M - 61
H - 42 K - 52 N - 62
I - 43 L - 53 O - 63
4 – 40 5 - 50 6 - 60
P - 71 W - 91
T - 81
R - 72 X - 92
U - 82
S - 73 Y - 93
V - 83
Q - 7* Z - 9#
8 - 80
7 – 70 9 - 90
*1 - Blank
*2 - : 0-00 #
*3 - ,
59
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
To activate LCD Messages (Custom/Pre-selected) from a station or from the system attendant,
Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
1. Dial 5 1.
2. Dial the 2-digit message code 00 or 11~20.
3. Press the [HOLD/SAVE] button.
Reference
1. Attendant : 2.13
2. Numbering Plan : 5.1 (set custom message)
Description
A user can select pre-assigned messages from 1 to 10 to be shown on the LCD of the calling party.
Detail information is entered by each user (e.g. Time, Date or Station number )
60
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Operation
To program Custom Message 00 from a station,
Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
1. Dial 5 2.(see Ref.2)
2. Enter the message(see Figure 2.4.1).
3. The message can be entered up to 24 characters.
4. Press the [HOLD/SAVE] button and confirmation tone is heard.
To activate LCD Messages (Custom/Pre-selected) from a station or from the system attendant,
Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
1. Dial 5 1.
2. Dial the 2-digit message code 00 or 01~10.
3. Press the [HOLD/SAVE] button.
Condition
1. If a station assigns call forward while pre-selected message is activated, the pre-selected
message is canceled automatically(see Ref.1).
2. User can leave a message in DKTU and SLT. When leave a message in SLT, DND warning tone
will be heard to notify it as soon as the handset is lifted.
3. When a pre-selected message is selected in a DKTU, the [DND/FOR] button will be flashing if
exists
Reference
1. Call Forward : 2.3.1
2. Numbering Plan : 5.1 (set custom message)
2.4.2 Alarm
Description
The system can be programmed to recognize the status of an external contact (normally open or
closed) from a relay. When activated, the system will signal programmed stations with a single tone
repeated per 1-min. interval or a continuous tone. This capability is commonly employed to provide
remote alarm signals. When used as an alarm, the assigned stations receive the programmed signal.
To stop the signal, the alarm should be deactivated (reset) from a station assigned to receive the alarm
signal.
Operation
61
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
At detecting the Alarm contact, the system sends the appropriate alarm signal to assigned stations.
To reset alarm;
Clear the alarm condition and reset (terminate) the alarm signal. The proceeding steps can be done in
any order to reset.
Condition
1. An external contact should be connected to the alarm input.
2. The alarm contacts should be “dry” (no voltage/current source connected).
3. SLT cannot receive alarm signal.
4. Alarm reset can be programmed in a flexible button.
Admin Programming
Alarm Enable 4.4.4.1 (PGM 163 – FLEX 1)
Alarm Contact Type 4.4.4.2 (PGM 163 – FLEX 2)
Alarm Mode 4.4.4.3 (PGM163 – FLEX 3)
Alarm Signal Mode 4.4.4.4 (PGM 163 – FLEX 4)
Station Alarm Attribute 4.1.4.10 (PGM 113 – FLEX10)
Description
By default, all conversation which take place on CO lines, intercom, and conference are protected by
privacy(Automatic privacy).
Automatic privacy allows a station user to suspend automatic privacy for an existing CO line
conversation without invitation.
ADMIN programming(ADMIN program 161 – FLEX 5) is required to enable or disable this feature.
If automatic privacy is set “enable” by ADMIN programming and press a busy CO line button, busy
tone will be heard.
If automatic privacy is set “disabled” by ADMIN programming and press a busy CO line button, the
station is connected to the conversation.
Condition
1. A station cannot override the other station during a conference though the privacy of conference
station is disabled.
2. While Automatic Privacy is disabled, privacy is still assured for intercom and conference calls.
3. A station can only override privacy-disabled station.
4. the station is heard Intrusion tone when another station accesses the line.
Admin Programming
Auto Privacy 4.4.2.5 (PGM 161 – FLEX 5)
62
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
A user can listen to BGM through the speaker while on-hook and idle.
Music from the source is heard over the station speaker and will be shut-off during ringing, paging
announcement or when the station is off-hook.
Operation
To assign background music at a station,
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Dial 7 3 and the music is heard.
Condition
1. When lifting handset or pressing [MON] button at a station, the music is not heard.
2. When an external music is assigned, the music source should be connected to MBU.
3. The same music source can be used with MOH.
4. Press the [VOLUME] button to adjust volume while the background music is heard.
5. The BGM may be blocked in an intercom box by pressing [DND/FOR] button.
Reference
1. MOH : 2.4.17
Admin Programming
Background Music Type 4.4.12.1 (PGM 171 – FLEX 1)
63
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
2.4.5 Camp-on
Description
When a user calls a busy station, busy tone is heard and the user can give a signal to the busy station.
The busy station (off-hook or on speakerphone) is notified of the call waiting by a camp-on tone and
flashing LED of the [HOLD/SAVE] button.
A user of SLT(single line telephone) may notify a busy station that an outside CO call or internal call is
waiting. The busy station is notified of the call by a camp-on tone.
Operation
To activate Call Wait while receiving intercom busy tone,
Dial or the last digit of the busy station or press the busy DSS flexible button, or flexible button
assigned as {Camp-On}.
¾ In case of SLT
To activate Call Waiting while receiving intercom busy tone,
1. Off-hook and dial * or the last digit of the dialed station number.
2. Await answer to announce the call.
3. Or, replace the handset and go on-hook.
Condition
1. To assign the {Camp-On} button at a flexible button,
[TRANS/PGM] + Flex. FLEX(to be assigned) + [TRANS/ PGM] + 8 5 + [HOLD/SAVE]
2. During a conference or paging, Call Waiting is not activated.(see Ref 2, Ref 3)
3. Camp-on is not applied to a station which is in DND.(see Ref.4)
4. The attendant can override a station using Camp-on feature.(see Ref.5)
5. If the ‘Stop Camp-on Tone’(ADMIN program 112 – FLEX 15) is set to ‘ENABLE’, the camp-on tone
will not be heard.
Reference
1. System Hold Code : 3.2.7(ADMIN 106 – FLEX 20)
2. Conference : 2.7
3. Paging : 2.8
4. DND : 2.4.9
5. Attendant Override : 2.13.5
Admin Programming
Stop Camp-on Tone 4.1.3.15 (PGM 112 – FLEX 15)
64
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Voice Over 4.1.4.6 (PGM 113 – FLEX 6) : Voice over is also applied to SLT.
Description
The ring tone signal used to notify stations of an incoming call can be changed in ADMIN programming
to provide distinctive ringing on per CO line basis. A distinctive ring tone can be programmed for each
CO line that is used to ring each station.
Admin Programming
CO Distinct Ring 4.2.3.5 (PGM 142 – FLEX 5)
Ring Frequency (PGM 422)
Description
Once Data Line Security(ADMIN program 111 – FLEX 4) is set on an station, communication between
the station and the other party is protected from signals such as overriding, Camp-on to the station(see
Ref.1).
Modems and fax stations should usually be given this status.
[Example]
Recalling/Transferring
Attendant Overriding
X
X
Make Call
Camp-On
Data Line X
Security On
The figure 2.4.1 describes that the station which is set Data Line Security to ON can be protected
65
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
1. If an analog extension (Data, Fax, Modem), which is assigned to data line security, makes an
external call via ISDN line, 3.1KHz Setup message will be sent to ISDN CO line instead of speech
Setup message.
2. If a busy station, which is assigned to data line security, receives an incoming CO call, the call is
disconnected with cause busy regardless of the DID/DISA Destination setting.
Reference
1. Camp-On : 2.4.5
2. Attendant Overriding : 2.13.5
3. Call transfer : 2.3.2
Admin Programming
Data Line Security 4.1.2.4 (PGM 111 – FLEX 4)
Description
The dialed phone number may not be displayed on the LCD of called station in calling with a speed
dial(see Ref.1).
Operation
To activate Dialing Security in calling with a speed dial
If pressing ‘ ’ button in front of the first digit in calling with a speed dial, it is operated with dialing
security.
1. Lift the Handset or press the [MON] button.
2. Press [SPEED] button.
3. Press ‘*’ button.
4. Dial speed number.
Condition
1. Dialed phone numbers with Dialing Security are included in the SMDR information(see Ref.2).
2. This feature applies to the transferred or recalled CO calls.
3. This feature applies to Redial operation(see Ref.3).
Reference
1. Speed Dialing : 2.2.8.4, 2.2.8.5
2. SMDR : 2.12
66
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
Placing a station in DND eliminates incoming outside line ringing, intercom calls, transfers and paging
announcements. While in DND, the station will not receive ring for CO lines. The Attendant can
override a station in DND(see Ref.1). Stations in DND can continue to make normal outgoing calls.
Station users can individually have the ability to place their station in DND(ADMIN program 114 –
FLEX 3). By default, DND is enabled at all stations.
Operation
To activate DND from a DKTU,
Press the [DND/FOR] button.
Condition
1. Pressing the [DND/FOR] button during call forward or pre-selected message, DND is not
activated and call forward or pre-selected message is released.
2. When a station, which is assigned to preset call forward, is in DND, an incoming call is received to
the next station by ring assignment(see Ref.2).
3. Attendant can override a station which is in DND by Camp-on or Intrusion(see Ref.1).
4. Attendant may cancel DND for a station or all stations.
Reference
1. Attendant Intrusion, Override : 2.13.4, 2.13.5
2. Ring Assignment : 2.1.1
Admin Programming
Do-Not-Disturb 4.1.2.3 (PGM 111 – FLEX 3)
Description
One Time DND allows a station user to turn off muted ringing that occurs while off hook(handset or
[MON]) on another call. Useful when having an important conversation and do not wish to be
disturbed by ringing. The station, while off hook, depresses the DND button which eliminates muted
67
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
ringing. When the station goes on-hook the DND button is extinguished and DND is cancelled.
Operation
To activate One-time DND from a DKTU,
1. While off-hook state or connecting a CO line or intercom call, press the [DND/FOR] button.
2. The station is in DND. (The LED of [DND/FOR] button will light.)
3. When the station goes to idle state, DND is released in the station. (The LED of [DND/FOR]
button will be extinguished.)
Admin Programming
Do-Not-Disturb 4.1.2.3 (PGM 111 – FLEX 3)
2.4.11 Flash
Description
CO Flash
Provides station users with the ability to terminate an outside call or transfer a call behind a key phone
system and restore dial tone without hanging up. A [FLASH] button is located on each DKTU.
The flash type and duration time of each CO line are assigned by the system.
Operation
To generate a flash while on a CO line;
Press the [FLASH] button.
Condition
1. The Flash command is not activated in ISDN CO line.
2. A station that isn’t permitted to access CO line cannot initiate a flash.
3. During a flash, the LED of CO line will be flashing.
Reference
1. Flash Command to CO Line Code : 3.2.7(ADMIN 106 – FLEX 11)
Admin Programming
Flash Type 4.2.2.7 (PGM 141 – FLEX 7)
68
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
Flexible buttons are customized by either ADMIN or station programming.
The list of programmable functions are summarized below:
¾ CO Line – Automatically accesses assigned line.(User Programmable)
¾ DSS/BLF – Automatically signal assigned station and provides BLF for off-hook and
DND.(User Programmable)
¾ Flexible Numbering Plan Code – Any Feature with a dialing code(Paging, Account code, Call
Park, etc) can be assigned to a flexible button. (User Programmable)
¾ Speed Dial – Automatically dials Speed Number.(System, Station, Saved Number Redial,
Last number Redial)(User Programmable)
¾ Group Access – Hunt Group pilot number.(User Programmable)
¾ Pool Group Access – Some or all outside lines can be grouped; pressing this button
accesses the highest numbered unused CO line in that group.(User Programmable)
¾ Loop – Used to answer a transferred call on l line for which a user does not have a button
assigned.(User Programmable)
¾ Station Assignment – Allows assignment of stations and complete flexibility within the system
numbering plan. A station can be assigned a number between 100-399.
¾ Telephone Number Assignment - Automatically dials outside Telephone Number.
(It can be possible LDP-6000/7000 which has 3 soft key.)
¾ 4/8 button – Feature code assign
Operation
The Flexible buttons are programmable individually at each keyset as follows;
1. DSS/BLF: Pressing the flexible button, it signals automatically the assigned station. (The LED
will light or flash in DND state.)
2. Features: Pressing the flexible button, it activates as dialing a feature code. (The LED will
illuminate.)
3. Speed Dial: Pressing the flexible button, CO line is seized and the stored phone number in the
bin is dialed.
4. POOL button: Pressing the flexible button, a CO line based on last choice or round robin in the
69
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
group is selected.
5. LOOP button: Pressing the flexible button, a CO line may be accessed
6. Telephone Number: Pressing the flexible button, it activates
Condition
1. A flexible button that is not assigned as {CO Line} button is considered as “Feature” button and is
programmable at each station. When ADMIN program 112 - FLEX 6 (CO Line Programming) is
enabled, the flexible button that is assigned as {CO line} button can be programmed.
2. To assign flexible button,
[TRANS/PGM] + Flex. BTN + [TRANS/PGM] + Feature Code + [HOLD/SAVE]
(Refer to 5.1.4: Flex Button Programming Code)
3. To assign direct button, (e.g. CO button or DSS button)
[TRANS/PGM] + Flex. BTN + Desired Code + [HOLD/SAVE]
4. To assign Telephone Number, (It can be possible LDP-6000/7000 which has 3 soft key.)
[TRANS/PGM] + Flex. BTN + [TEL NUM] + Desired Code + [HOLD/SAVE]
Admin Programming
Flexible Button Assignment 4.1.6 (PGM 115)
CO Line Programming 4.1.3.6 (PGM 112 – FLEX 6)
2.4.13 Headset
Description
An industry standard headset can be connected to a station instead of handset. The station is
programmed for headset operation in place of speakerphone operation. A user can use headset
instead of handset to make or answer a call.
Operation
To change the station mode between Speakerphone or Headset,
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Dial code 7 5.
3. The Station Answer mode is displayed on the LCD.
4. Dial code 1 (Speaker mode) or 0 (Headset mode).
Condition
1. The intercom signaling mode (HF/TN/PV – [TRANS/PGM]+1+2) can be set in headset mode
70
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Admin Programming
Headset Ring Mode 4.1.2.10 (PGM 111 – FLEX 10)
Speakerphone/Headset 4.1.2.11 (PGM 111 – FLEX 11)
Description
Users can control the method by which they receive intercom calls and signals.
stations equipped with the speakerphone can select one from the 3 signaling modes as below;
TN - Tone ringing
A standard tone ring notifies the party of an incoming intercom call. The called party answers by lifting
the handset or press [MON] button.
Operation
To assign the Intercom Signal mode from a keyset,
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Dial 1 2 and confirmation tone is heard.
3. Dial the signal mode type (1 = HF/2 =TN/3 = PV).
4. Press the [HOLD/SAVE] button and confirmation tone is heard.
Condition
1. In Message Wait/ICM Queuing/Call Transfer/ Attendant Override, the ring is received with TN
mode regardless of the assigned Intercom Signal mode(see Ref.1, Ref.2, Ref.3).
2. Intercom signal mode will not affect the voice announcements from internal/all call paging(see
Ref.4).
Reference
71
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
A station can be assigned to one of the Intercom Tenancy Groups. Each Intercom Tenancy Group can
be operated independently and the stations in the group can be assigned an individual CO group to
use. Maximum 5 Intercom Tenancy Groups can be assigned in the IP LDK-20.
Each group can be assigned with attendant(intercom tenancy group attendant) and can be
programmed to allow or deny calls to other groups (allowed access groups). Stations in a group are
allowed access to other stations based on the allowed access of the calling group (setting with station
base).
72
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
The figure 2.4.2 describes that when a call to other intercom tenancy group is not allowed, CO line
call or Station call, pick-up or transfer cannot be activated and each group will be operated as
different system.
The figure 2.4.3 describes that when a call to other intercom tenancy group is allowed, CO line call
or Station call, pick-up or transfer is activated.
Condition
1. When a call to other Intercom Tenancy Group is denied, pick-up cannot be activated.
2. It is not allowed to stations to have the same station numbers though they belong to different
intercom tenancy group.
3. The attendant of Intercom Tenancy Group can be any station in the system and it is not affected by
Intercom Tenancy Group access.
4. When the attendant of Intercom Tenancy Group sets Day/Night/Weekend mode, it will affect only
the Intercom Tenancy Group.
Reference
1. Pick-Up : 2.3.4
Admin Programming
Intercom Group Number 4.1.2.13 (PGM 111 – FLEX 13)
Intercom Tenancy Group 4.1.11 (PGM 120)
73
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
Message Wait
A station user can notify another station user that he wishes to talk to the user. The notified station
user can return the call or the message left on the station. when responding to the station, the user
can answer the message left on the station in sequential order. There are up to 5 messages left at one
station.
Call Back
A station can initiate a call back request to busy station. Once that station becomes idle. The station
that left the call back request is signaled.
A station with a message waiting can receive a periodic audible reminder of the message waiting. This
tone is sent to stations only while idle and is presented over the speaker.
Operation
To leave a message wait to an idle station that does not answer,
1. Press the [CALLBK] button and receive confirmation tone.
2. The LED of the [CALLBK] button at the receiving station will flash.
¾ In case of SLT
To leave a message wait,
1. Press hook-switch.
2. Dial 5 5 6(Message Wait/Callback Enable : see Ref.1).
3. Confirmation tone is heard and replace the handset.
74
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
1. The callback will ring with Tone mode regardless of intercom signaling mode(see Ref.3).
2. A station can leave only one callback or message. A new request will override the previous one.
3. Message wait data will be protected with power failure.
4. When dialing the station number instead of pressing the [CALLBK] button to answer a message
wait, the message wait will be canceled in the calling station.
5. Message wait reminder tone is programmable from 00 to 60 min. If you don’t want to present the
tone, the timer may be set to 00.
6. Message wait reminder tone is not heard at a busy station.
7. Message wait reminder tone will continue until all the messages are retrieved.
When a station attempts to leave a message at a station which has already 5 messages and one of
those is not equal to the attempting station, error tone will be heard. When VMIB access is allowed
in the station, after recording VMIB message, it turns to normal message in the station. In this case,
error tone will not be provided in the attempting station.
¾ In case of SLT
1. If a voice message is recorded in a SLT, the recorded message will be played by dialing
message wait retrieval code (5 5 7). The played message will be deleted automatically after
being played.
2. When user dials 5 5 7 to retrieve voice message wait, the only one message is played. After the
first message is played, warning tone will be heard to indicate remained messages. To retrieve
another message, dial 5 5 7 again.
Reference
1. Message Wait/Callback Enable Code : 3.2.7(ADMIN 106 – FLEX 13)
2. Message Wait/Callback Enable Code : 3.2.7(ADMIN 106 – FLEX 14)
3. Intercom Signaling Mode : 2.4.14
4. DND : 2.4.9
75
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
When a CO call is placed on hold (system, exclusive, transfer, conference, etc), the external party will
hear music. In this way, the CO line party can be notified that the connection is still established.
MOHU
The figure 2.4.4 describes that MOH is supplied through various music sources.
Music can be played to any party on hold. The following music sources are available:
¾ Internal Music
¾ External Music
¾ SLT MOH
¾ VMIB MOH (VMIB MOH Recording 2.4.17.2)
Condition
1. Only 1 MOH channels are supported.
2. SLT ports connected with MOHU can provide MOH channels.
Reference
1. Hold : 2.3.3.1
Admin Programming
CO Line MOH 4.2.3.6 (PGN 142 – FLEX 6)
MOH Type 4.4.12.2 (PGM 171 – FLEX 2)
76
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
When a CO line call is placed in the hold state (system, exclusive, transfer, conference, etc), the
external party will hear music. In this way, the CO line party can be notified that the connection is still
established.
Operation
1.SLT MOH Type Assign
[TRANS/PGM] + 171 + [FLEX 4] + Enter SLT Station Number + [HOLD/SAVE]
[TRANS/PGM] + 171 + [FLEX 2] + Enter SLT MOH type(4 ~ 8) + [HOLD/SAVE]
Condition
1. SLT ports connected with MOHU can provide MOH channels.
2. Up to 5 SLT ports can be used as MOH channel.
3. To use SLT port as a MOH channel, assign desired SLT port with MOH channel and then connect
MOHU to the SLT port.
Admin Programming
CO Line MOH 4.2.3.6 (PGN 142 – FLEX 6)
MOH Type 4.4.12.2 (PGM 171 – FLEX 2)
Assign SLT MOH 4.4.12.4 (PGM 171 – FLEX 4)
Description
Attendant can record VMIB MOH announcement and it can be used as the MOH source of the system.
0: Not assigned by this field.
3 : VMIB MOH
9: Hold Tone
Operation
To set the VMIB MOH as MOH source,
Set the MOH type as VMIB MOH type by Admin programming.
[TRANS/PGM] + 171 + [FLEX 2] + Enter VMIB Port No.(3) + [HOLD/SAVE]
77
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
1. VMIB MOH message should be recorded before setting VMIB MOH as system MOH source.
2. While attendant operates system greetings and prompt including VMIB MOH, VMIB MOH is
stopped.
3. When VMIB MOH is used as system MOH, 1 port of VMIB should be always reserved for MOH
even though MOH is not used.
Admin Programming
MOH Type 4.4.12.2 (PGM 171 – FLEX 2)
2.4.18 Mute
Description
During a conversation, if pressing the [MUTE] button, a station user can disable the handset or the
speakerphone to consult privately with others while listening to the other party on the phone through
the handset or speaker. If pressing the [MUTE] button again, it reactivates the microphone.
Operation
To mute the transmitting audio,
Press the [MUTE] button, and LED of the [MUTE] button is illuminated. The connected party cannot
hear the voice of muted station.
To restore transmission,
Press the illuminated [MUTE] button. LED of [MUTE] button is extinguished and transmission is
restored.
Condition
1. Changing from the speakerphone to handset, the mute is released.
2. Selecting another DSS button, mute state will not be changed.
Description
If the SLT station that has the message wait indication lamp receives message from another users,
then the lamp of SLT will flash. It indicates that it has the waiting message.
Condition
1. When lifting handset, user will hear DND warning tone for indicating message waiting.
2. When message waiting indication prompt is recorded in system greeting 097, voice announcement
will be heard instead of DND warning tone.
Admin Programming
78
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
A station can make a call without lifting the handset by using a speakerphone or monitor mode.
If this feature dose not operate, check the speakerphone “able” or “enable”. the station without
speakerphone dose not operate.
Operation
When Auto Speaker Selection(ADMIN program 111 – FLEX 1) is ON,
Assign CO line/Intercom/Speed Dial to a flexible button and press the flexible button. Then it is
operated immediately.
Admin Programming
Auto Speaker Selection 4.1.2.1 (PGM 111 – FLEX 1)
Description
The system will allow station users to dial station numbers by entering a name that has been
programmed for the station (intercom). Also each station may be assigned with a name up to 7
characters and speed dial (system and station) number may be assigned with a name of up to 16
characters. When the names are programmed in the digital display keyset, the user may select a
station or speed dial number by the name. The user selects from one of three directories (intercom,
user speed dial or system speed dial) and enters alpha-numeric data with 2 dial pad keystrokes per
character. The system finds and displays the first matched name based on the characters stored. The
user may at any point scroll using [ ]/[ ] buttons through the names in the directory and select a
name to call. If user wants to display the matched phone number to the selected name, press
[FLASH] button.
Operation
To register Station Name
[TRANS/PGM] + 74 + Enter Name(7 Characters) + [HOLD/SAVE]
79
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Q – 11 A - 21 D - 31
Z – 12 B - 22 E - 32
. – 13 C - 23 F - 33
1 – 10 2 - 20 3 - 30
G – 41 J - 51 M - 61
H - 42 K - 52 N - 62
I - 43 L - 53 O - 63
4 – 40 5 - 50 6 - 60
P - 71 W - 91
T - 81
R - 72 X - 92
U - 82
S - 73 Y - 93
V - 83
Q - 7* Z - 9#
8 - 80
7 – 70 9 - 90
*1 - Blank
*2 - : 0-00 #
*3 - ,
80
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
1. Dial by name is only available to a DKTU with LCD for programmed names.
2. The name should be registered to use 'Dial By Name'.
3. If you dial a group (I/S/U) which has no entry, error tone will be heard.
4. In SLT and DKTU with no LCD, only the station name can be entered.
5. The speed dial which has only phone number without name will not be listed by Dial By Name.
6. Pressing the [CALLBK] button, the last letter of user input is deleted and the previous matched
name is displayed. Pressing the [CALLBK] button without entering any letter, there is no action in
the system.
7. For entering alpha-numeric data, see the English Character Set.
Reference
1. Programming Mode Enter Code : 3.2.7(ADMIN 106 – FLEX 20)
Description
The system supports multiple hierarchical menus based on station programming. User can make
station programming by selecting desired menu. Attendant also can make station programming and
attendant programming with the same way. (Ref.1).
81
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Operation
To enter programming mode,
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. You may find the following menu;(Description : 2.4.22.1)
To select a menu,
1. Dial the number of desired menu item to select the menu.
2. If the selected menu is programming item, it enters to programming mode.
3. If there is available sub-menu, selectable menu is displayed on the LCD.
Condition
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button to move the top menu.
2. Press the [REDIAL] button to move the previous menu.
3. After a menu is programmed, the previous menu list is displayed on the LCD.
4. Pressing a flexible button in main menu mode, it enters flexible button programming mode.
Reference
1. Station Programming : 5.1 (1)
82
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
The Station Relocation Feature lets a user unplug their station and plug it into another location. Dialing
a code followed by the old station number brings all the station attributes including station number,
button mapping, speed dial, and class of service(see Ref.3) to the new location.
Operation
To store the station attributes to a temporary buffer,
Dial the feature code [TRANS] * 1 (Station Relocation Backup).
Unplug the station.
Condition
1. All information for the port of destination station will be retained so that it may be copied or
relocated to another port.
2. It is possible for the same station type.
3. If a different station type is plugged, preprogrammed {DSS} buttons are not guaranteed.
4. DKTUs must be relocated to another digital port, DKTUs cannot be relocated to an SLT port.
Reference
1. Class of Service : 2.5.4
Description
With DSS flexible buttons, users can place consecutive intercom calls without the need for regaining
intercom dial tone (no need to hang-up) between calls. The user can simply press the appropriate
DSS flexible button.
Operation
To use serial calling,
Press the appropriate DSS flexible button, the old call is disconnected and the new call will be
established.
83
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
In an outgoing call, the ISDN network will send time & date in CONNECT message when the called
party answers. The time & date of the system may be modified by next time & date optionally one time
in a day.
Operation
To set the time & date by Digital Network,
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Dial 0 4 6 and 1 (Yes).
3. Press the [HOLD/SAVE] button.
Condition
1. This feature may be set at Attendant station and by Admin Programming.
2. It may set time & date to default value or be useful to assign summer time.
Description
This feature provides voice announcements for a busy station without interrupting the existing
conversation. The announcement is received over the existing conversation so that only the busy
station hears both incoming parties. The user can talk back to other party and alternate conversation
between the parties.
Operation
1. A busy station is called and camped-on by a new caller(see Ref.1)
2. The busy station hears a warning tone over the current voice path.
3. The busy station is connected with both a current caller and a new caller. (the busy station can
send and receive voice to both simultaneously (both mean the current caller and the new caller), in
other words both hear the voice of the busy station simultaneously and the busy station hear the
voice of both simultaneously. But a new caller and a current caller can not send and receive voice
each other).
4. The [HOLD/SAVE] LED flashes at 60 ipm.
5. Press the flashing [HOLD/SAVE] button of the busy station.
6. A current caller hears MOH if provided.
7. The busy station is connected with a new caller.
8. Alternate between calls by pressing [HOLD/SAVE] button again.
Condition
84
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Reference
1. Camp-On : 2.4.5
2. MOH : 2.4.17
Admin Programming
Voice Over 4.1.4.6 (PGM 113 – FLEX 6)
2.4.27 Wakeup
Description
Each attendant or station user can set an alarm for any time as a wake-up call or reminder. This
feature can be programmed to activate only once or daily. If the user goes off-hook during the alarm,
he hears special dial tone.
Operation
To register a wake-up time from the attendant station,
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Dial 0 4 2.
3. Dial the station range to be alerted, if a single station is to receive alarm, enter ' ' instead of the
second station.
4. Dial 2-digit hour and minute for alerting (24-hour mode).
5. Dial '#' for wake-up alarm until canceled, if not it is canceled automatically after the first wake-
up alarm ringing.
6. Press the [HOLD/SAVE] button.
85
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
1. If the wake-up alarm is registered at a station, ' ' is displayed in front of the present time on the
LCD.
2. If the VMIB is installed, voice message for the wake-up time is heard 3 times and MOH is heard
3. If the wake-up ring is not answered for 3 times, it is canceled.
4. If system attendant dials to wake-up fail station to erase wake-up fail ring, the fail ring will
disappear with confirmation tone. But when the Wake-up Fail Ring timer expires, confirmation tone
will not be provided and just the fail ring will disappear.
5. If [Wake-up Fail Ring Timer] is 0, wake-up fail ring will not disappear automatically.
6. If [Wake-up Fail Ring Timer] is 99, the fail ring is not given to attendant station.
7. If [Wake-up Fail Ring Timer] is 1~98, after Wake-up Fail Ring Timer expires, the wake-up fail ring
will disappear automatically.
Admin Programming
Wake-up Fail Ring Timer 4.5.3.7 (PGM 182 - FLEX 7)
Description
The system can determine if an incoming call from the preprogrammed CO line is for FAX (facsimile)
or for speech terminal by detecting the tone of the call (1100Hz, 0.5s ON/3s OFF repeated). When the
system detects a FAX tone from the incoming line within predetermined time, the system transfers the
call to the station that is a Fax machine. If the FAX tone is not detected within predetermined time,
system gives rings to stations that are programmed to ring.
Condition
1. Only one CO line can be programmed as a FAX CO line. If the FAX CO line is not programmed,
Automatic Fax Transfer will not be activated.
2. Station 17 is used as the FAX Station So, FAX machine should be connected to the port for station
17 to use this feature.
3. If the FAX tone is not detected within the FAX tone detection time, the system will give rings to the
stations that are programmed to ring.
4. If the FAX CO line is not answered within the FAX CO call time, the line will be released.
86
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
5. Outside caller connected to the FAX CO line can hear the ring back tone while system is detecting
a FAX tone.
6. In order to transfer calls only from FAX to the FAX station, do not assign CO ring to the FAX
station 17.
7. If a CO line is programmed for DISA and for Automatic FAX Transfer as well, incoming calls from
that CO line are served as DISA calls. So, if a user wants to call the FAX station, just call station
17 by exploiting DISA call.
8. When the FAX machine goes to idle after a FAX call, the associated CO line is released
9. If the FAX CO line is disconnected (“disconnect clear”) during a FAX call, CO line is released and
FAX machine becomes idle.
10. Only Analog lines are possible to use this feature.
Admin Programming
Auto FAX Transfer CO (PGM161, FLEX17 )
FAX tone Detect Timer(PGM182, FLEX13)
FAX CO Call Timer(PGM182,FLEX14)
Description
A mobile user is able to use the phone as extension of LDK system. So he can receive the incoming
call and make the outgoing call when a user registers the mobile phone number to LDK system.
Operation
To register the mobile extension number in DKT.
1. Press the [PGM] + 33.
2. Dial the mobile number
3. Press the [HOLD] button.
87
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
1. The mobile extension user dials his DID number of LDK system.
2. Then he receives the internal dial tone
3. He can do internal call or outgoing call with CLI number of extension.
Condition
1. If the extension is busy, forward or DND state, a call is not routed to the mobile extension..
2. If the mobile extension does the external call through LDK system, it sends the CLI number of
extension. But, in this case, the mobile extension does not use the transfer feature
3. After no answer timer, a call is routed to DID no answer destination. (In case the no answer timer
of LDK system is shorter than GSM)
4. This feature is applied to only ISDN DID Line.
5. The Message wait or Call Back feature is not supported to the mobile extension.
6. The networking feature is not supported to the mobile extension.
7. If mobile extension converse through LDK, DTMF receiver is dedicated for mobile extension.
Admin Programming
1. Mobile extension register (PGM 236)
Operation
When ‘CO to CO unsupervised conference timer extend’ feature is activated, two analog CO lines on
connection hears warning tone before 15 seconds of the unsupervised conference timer expired. the
warning tone is provided to indicate the disconnection.
Condition
To use this feature, at least one IDLE DTMF devices must be existed.
This feature is only available at analog CO-to-CO connection by DISA or off-net call forward.
Admin Programming
Unsupervised Conference Timer Extend Enable (PGM 160 – FLEX button 18)
Unsupervised Conference Timer Extend Code (PGM 109 – FLEX Button 6)
Unsupervised Conference Timer (PGM182 – FLEX Button 6)
88
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
A DKTU caller can change the answer mode of called party DKT temporary.(tone mode -> hands free
mode )
Operation
To activate forced hands free mode
1. Call to DKT which is a tone mode.
2. When user hears a ring back tone, dial Forced hands free Code ( ‘#’ )
3. Called party DKT stop ringing and speaker and microphone are activated. (Operate as hands free
mode)
Condition
1. If DKT is changed to hands free mode, the connection tone is provided and the voice path is
connected.
2. If called party DKT is set a linked-pair station, the answer mode of called party will be not changed.
3. If calling party DKT is set a linked-pair station, the calling party DKT can use the Forced Hands
free Mode.
4. Only the calling party DKT of which value of PGM 111-19 is ON can use this feature.
5. After connection, related feature with hands free mode is not applied.( ex. call back ).
Admin Programming
Forced hands free mode enable/disable issue for Caller(PGM 111-19)
Description
A hot desk enables that user can dynamically select a station by login / logout operation without
having a fixed station. For a call center, marketing department people can share working place with
one another. A user can use dummy station using log-in operation. And a user log-out when station
becomes useless
Operation
Login operation at dummy station
1. User offhook or press [MON] button.
2. Dial the authorization code and ‘#’ (end mark of authorization code. If 5 digits authorization mode,
‘#’ is no need).
3. Station restore user database (station number, COS, ring assign, etc...) and can receive incoming
ring
Logout operation
1. Press [PGM] + * + * (User Logout) or press [Agent Logout] flex button.
2. User select call forward type using volume up/down key.
Supported forward type : offnet speed 000, Mobile extension, VMIB or VM group.
3. Press [HOLD] button.
4. User database is saved and station becomes dummy.
Condition
89
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
1. A dummy station shows “DUMMY STATION (xxx)”. (“xxx” is the physical staion number)
2. A dummy station only allows login operation. all other operations are not allowed.
3. A logout operation is only allowed for dummy station which a user has logged-in.
4. Total number of user is restricted by system station capacity.
( Total number of hot-desk user = 26(26 : From the total number of station 28, last station port is
used for modem and one extra port is reserved.))
For example in IP LDK-20;
If DTIB8 is installed, the total station number installed are 16, then maximum number of hot-desk
User is 10 ( 26 – 16)
7. If user tries to log-in to another station without log-out operation, the previous used station become
to dummy station automatically.
8. The hot-desk will be automatically log-off if the KTU does not operate any action within “Auto Log-
Out Timer”.
9. The button map of hot-desk will not be changed even though he log-on to the different type of
DKTU.
(Recommend to connect the same type of DKTU for Hot-Desk station due to the button map.)
10. Only DKT (has more than 12 button) and WKT can be used as a dummy station
11. Modem associated station cannot log in. (which is set at PGM [170])
12. When system reset happens, all login agents are logout automatically.
13. The Agent can’t be the slave station of linked pair stations.
Admin Programming
Dummy station on / off ( PGM 112 / B TN 23 )
Number of agents (PGM 250 / BTN 1)
Assign station number of agents (PGM 250 / BTN 2)
Agent auto logout timer (PGM 250 / BTN 3)
Description
LCOB board of IP LDK-20 system can detect FSK Type I CID signal with its option boards.
IP LDK-20 supports Bellcore & ETSI and UK, BT SIN 227 & SIN 242.
To use BT type CID, the hardware(MBU, LCOB and SLIB) for BT CID should be used.
Operation
1. Incoming call arrives to a LCOB line which has a FSK CID detection optional board.
2. Optional board detects FSK CID signal.
90
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Admin Programming
CIDU Setting (PGM 185)
Condition
1. If an incoming CO is assigned to multiple SLTs of a same slot, the CO rings are generated
sequentially with 1 second interval to the SLTs. And CLI is displayed on SLT after first ring.
2. For CLI display on SLT, ring phase (PGM 182, Button 4) more than 4 seconds is recommended.
If Ring phase is less than 4 seconds, some of the SLT can not receive CLI display signal.
3. CLI Type I is supported for SLT. CLI is not transferred to the SLT for screened transfer.
Description
The call log feature enables the LDP series or LKD series user to view a log of the last (15-50)
incoming and outgoing calls. The user can scroll the list of numbers stored, select the desired
number and activate a redial to that number.
The log includes the CLI (or dialed number), the time, the date and station/system speed name of the
call, it is stored on the MPB and so is retained if the Key Station is unplugged or replaced.
The call-logs for Incoming/Outgoing/Lost call are available. (Incoming/Outgoing call log list number
per station: PGM160-Flex19, range15-50). Outgoing call log is same as Redial list and Lost call log is
same as CLI Message wait. To use call log, “CALL LOG button” program is need.
Operation
LKD-30D
91
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
1. Press the flexible button that has been programmed as the CALL LOG button.
To select the call type, press {Up} or {Down} of Volume key
2. To select the call type(Received Call/ Dialed Call), press {UP} or {DOWN}.
3. The user can scroll through the numbers by pressing the Volume Up/Down buttons.
When the CLI of the desired number is displayed, press the {HOLD} key and the system will
establish a call to that number.
4. To view Lost call(CLI MSG Wait), press [CALLBK] button.
LDP-7024LD
1. Press the flexible button that has been programmed as the CALL LOG button.
2. Select the call log type by pressing UP or DOWN of navigation key.
3. The user can select the desired number and press SEND to establish a call to that number or press
DETAIL to display the time and date of the selected call before pressing SEND.
Admin Programming
1. CALL LOG List number (PGM160-Flex19)
2. CLI MSG-Wait ( PGM 114 Flex 4)
Condition
1. To use this feature, a user should program ‘Call Log button’ in flexible button.
2. A user can program ‘Call log list number’ per station. (PGM160-Flex19, Range 15-50)
3. In case a user program ‘call log list number’, all call log database will be initialized.
4. Maximum call log list per system is 500 for LDK-20.
5. The system assigns the call log list from the physical port 1 in order.
6. Must enable CLI MSG-Wait for the LOST call log.
Description
An account code is used to identify outgoing call for accounting and billing purposes, the account code
is appended to SMDR Call record. So company use account code for each station user so that the
company can determine what calls were made for station users, and can submit a bill to the station
users according to the station user’s account code on the SMDR call record.
An account code may use the digits “0” through “11”(Maximum 12).
Operation
To enter an account code before accessing a CO line,
1. Press the {ACCOUNT CODE} flexible button.
2. Dial the account code (max. 12 digits) or mark , then reconnected to the external party.
3. Intercom dial tone is heard.
4. Seize a CO line to make a call.
92
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
To enter an account code without {ACCOUNT CODE} flexible button during a conversation with an
external party,
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Dial 5 5 0(SMDR Account Enter Code : see Ref.1).
3. Dial the account code (maximum 12 digits) or mark , then reconnected to the external party.
Condition
1. For DKTUs, you may assign a flexible button as {ACCOUNT CODE} to access the account code
feature.
[TRANS/PGM] + Flex. BTN + [TRANS/PGM] + 8 0 + [HOLD/SAVE]
2. While entering account code, it is impossible to talk to the other party.
3. The user may enter the account code before a call conversation is established.
Reference
1. SMDR Account Enter Code : 3.2.7(ADMIN 106 – FLEX 7)
Description
When a station user can make a CO line call, if the station is programmed to enter the authorization
code by ADMIN programming, the authorization code must be entered. An authorization code must be
assigned through ADMIN programming.
If a third party discovers the personal authorization code, there will be a risk that they will make
fraudulent phone calls using the telephone, and the cost will be charged to your account. In order to
avoid this problem, 1) specify a complicated authorization code as random as you can make it, 2)
change the authorization code frequently.
An authorization code is assigned as 5 digits or variable length(3~11digits). Authorization code can not
be duplicated.
Operation
To access a CO line when authorization codes are required,
1. Attempt a CO line access, and DND warning tone is heard.
2. Enter the authorization code and ‘#’ (end mark of authorization code, If 5 digits authorization
mode, ‘#’ is no need.).
3. If valid, the CO line is connected and if not valid, you will hear error tone.
93
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
1. The total number of authorization code in the system is 200 for IP LDK-20.
2. The same authorization code cannot be assigned.
3. To register the authorization code in a station,
[TRANS/PGM] + 3 1 + authorization code + [HOLD/SAVE]
4. To change the authorization code in a station,
5 Digits Authorization Mode
[TRANS/PGM] + 3 2 + current authorization code + new authorization code + [HOLD/SAVE]
Reference
1. LCR : 2.2.7
Admin Programming
Authorization Code 4.11.1 (PGM 227)
DISA Account Code 4.2.2.3 (PGM 141 – FLEX 3)
CO Line Group Account 4.2.2.9 (PGM 141 – FLEX 9)
Loop LCR Account Code 4.1.2.16 (PGM111 – FLEX 16)
5 Digits Authorization Code usage 4.4.2.21 (PGM161 – FLEX 21)
Description
When a station does not initiate dialing on an outgoing CO line or receive no answer on an intercom
call, the system will return the CO line or the called station to idle based on the assigned Auto Release
Timer(ADMIN program 180 – FLEX 14). If on the speaker phone or monitor mode, the station will
return to idle, otherwise the station will receive error tone if using the handset.
Condition
1. Intercom call in H/P mode(see Ref.1) is regarded that it is answered and Station Auto Release is
not activated.
2. When the Automatic Release time is assigned to 0, Auto Call Release is not activated.
3. While making a call without lifting handset and Auto Release timer is expired, the call is canceled
and the station will go idle state automatically.
4. While making a call with lifting handset and the Auto Release timer is expired, the call is canceled
and the station will receive error tone.
94
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Reference
1. Intercom Signal Mode : 2.4.14
Admin Programming
Automatic CO Release Timer 4.5.1.14 (PGM 180 – FLEX 14)
Station Auto Release Timer 4.5.3.5 (PGM 182 – FLEX 5)
Description
Each station and CO line may be assigned to have different class to allow or restrict call service. The
level of COS assignments are programmed to each station and CO line. Applied dialing restrictions are
the result of the interaction of COS assignments as shown below.
¾ Class of service
CO Line COS
1 2 3 4 5
Canned
1 Unrestricted Unrestricted Unrestricted Unrestricted
Restricted
Canned
2 Table A Table A Unrestricted Unrestricted
Restricted
Canned
S 3 Table B Unrestricted Table B Unrestricted
Restricted
T
A Canned
4 Table A,B Table A Table B Unrestricted
Restricted
C Canned Canned Canned Canned
5 Unrestricted
O Restricted2 Restricted2 Restricted2 Restricted1
S Canned Canned Canned Canned
6 Unrestricted
Restricted1 Restricted1 Restricted1 Restricted1
Intercom Intercom
7 Intercom Only Intercom Only Intercom Only
Only Only
Canned
8 Table C Table C Unrestricted Unrestricted
Restricted1
Canned
9 Table D Table D Unrestricted Unrestricted
Restricted1
z Canned, Restricted1 : Long distance call is not allowed.(allows 8 digits dialing maximum)
z Canned, Restricted2 : Long distance call is not allowed.
(The dialed digits can be longer then 8 digits)
¾ Station COS
COS 1 There is no restriction to dial.
COS 2 Monitored by Exception Table A
95
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
¾ CO COS
COS 1 There is no restriction. Monitored by STA COS.
COS 2 Monitored by Exception Table A & STA COS 2/4.
COS 3 Monitored by Exception Table B & STA COS 2/4.
COS 4 Long distance call is not allowed for all STA COS. Max. 8 digits may be dialed.
COS 5 Overrides STA COS 2,3,4,5,6. (No COS restriction)
¾ CO to CO line COS
COS 1 There is no restriction to dial.
COS 2 Monitored by Exception Table A
COS 3 Monitored by Exception Table B
COS 4 Monitored by Exception Table A & B
COS 5 Long distance call is not allowed. (The dialed digits can be longer than 8 digits.)
COS 6 Long distance call is not allowed. Only max. 8 digits may be dialed.
COS 7 Only intercom, paging and emergency call are allowed. No dialing allowed on CO lines.
COS 8 Monitored by Exception Table C
COS 9 Monitored by Exception Table D
Condition
1. Rule of COS
In STA COS 7, no dialing is allowed to CO line.
In CO COS 5, STA COS 1~6 is ignored and there is no restriction to access CO line.
In CO COS 4, STA COS 1~6 is ignored. The long distance call is not allowed and max. 8 digits
may be dialed.
In CO COS 1, it is restricted by STA COS.
In CO COS 2 and STA COS 2/4, it is restricted by Exception Table A. There is no restriction in
STA COS 1/3. In STA COS 5, long distance call is not allowed and max. 8 digits can be dialed.
96
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
3. General Conditions
If ‘Incoming CO Call Toll Check’ is set, the COS rule is applied when the station dials digits after
answering the incoming CO call.
Admin Programming
Station COS 4.1.7 (PGM 116)
CO line COS 4.2.2.2 (PGM 141 – FLEX 2)
CO to CO COS 4.4.7 (PGM 166)
Toll Exception Table 4.10.1 (PGM 224)
Canned Toll Exception Tables 4.10.2 (PGM 225)
Incoming Toll Check 4.4.2.16 (PGM 161 – FLEX 16)
Description
Up to 10 speed number zones can be defined. Speed bins & stations can be allocated to these zones.
Toll checks based on COS can be applied to zones(see Ref.1). Only stations allocated to zones can
access these bins. Speed bins not allocated to zones can be accessed by all stations and no toll
checks are applied
Reference
1. COS : 2.5.4
Admin Programming
Speed Dial Access 4.1.3.9 (PGM 112 – FLEX 9)
System Speed Zone Range 4.12.5.1 (PGM 232)
System Speed Zone Access 4.12.5.2 (PGM 232)
CO Dial Tone Detect 4.4.1.6 (PGM 160 – FLEX 6)
Description
This feature allows to temporarily override toll restriction and makes a toll call from toll restricted phone.
It is activated by entering a feature code or pressing programmed {Walking COS} flexible button and
97
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
the authorization code before accessing a CO line. The authorization code(see Ref.1) can be used as
a verified account code for SMDR(see Ref.2).
Operation
To activate this feature from a DKTU,
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Dial 2 3.
3. Confirmation tone will be heard and enter the authorization code.
4. If the authorization code is accorded, intercom dial tone will be heard. (At this time, the used
extension COS(see Ref.3) is changed to the station’s COS that is accorded to the entered
authorization code temporarily.)
5. You can place a CO line call only one time.
Condition
1. To program {Walking COS} flexible button,
[TRANS/PGM] + Flex. BTN + [TRANS/PGM] + 2 3 + [HOLD/SAVE]
2. This feature can be used at DKTU and SLT.
3. This feature is available for only one time. While you are activating this feature, if you hang up or
press the [TRANS/PGM] button to hold the call and seize other line, then the COS of station used
is recovered to original COS.
4. When you dialed wrong number, press the [FLASH] button to dial again without changing CO line.
5. The fee for a call with Walking COS will be charged to the station which is accorded to the
authorization code, not the actual using station.
6. When a user tries to make Walking COS to a station which is set to COS 7 with temporary COS,
COS of the call will follow the original COS of the station.
Reference
1. Authorization : 2.5.2
2. SMDR : 2.12
3. COS : 2.5.4
Admin Programming
Authorization Code 4.11.1 (PGM 227)
98
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
Stations can be grouped so that incoming calls may be routed to an idle station in the group.
The number of Hunt group and the number of station in a group as follows;
Several VMIB announcements may be provided to the Hunt group. If a call is not answered until the
1st Announcement Timer expires. The second announcement will be provided if the call continues to
wait beyond the queue to the 2nd Announcement Timer. The second announcement may be repeated
until the call is answered or disconnected by user’s choice.
[ VMIB announcement ]
LDK system supports first and secondary VMIB announcements for hunt group. When a call is
arrived to hunt group, pre-assigned VMIB announcement will be played to the caller, if VMIB
announcement is set and its timer is expired. Furthermore if the call is not answered until second
announcement timer is expired, this announcement will be played. Also, this secondary
announcement can be repeated as its programming.(see Ref.1)
[ Overflow destination ]
If overflow timer is expired and nobody answers a call, the call will be diverted to overflow destination.
This overflow destination can be a extension, a group, VMIB announcement, and system speed.
[ Wrap-up Timer ]
When a member of hunt group goes to idle, LDK system will not give a call to that member. After
wrap-up timer goes, the member goes to real idle state which can serve a hunt call.
[ Music source ]
LDK system supports 8 kinds of music source for hunt group instead of ring back tone. When a call
goes to queue, a caller will hear any music source which is pre-assigned. (see Ref.2)
99
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
1. A station can be a member of plural Hunt groups and the group should be the same type of Hunt
group.
2. A station in DND/Forward state will not receive group call.
3. Transferred ring to Hunt group is not recalled.
4. When a call is received in a Hunt group, the call will be in the ring process before receiving the
announcement for Hunt group Announcement time. If no Hunt group announcement is assigned,
the timer is ignored. If the timer is set to 0, the call will receive the announcement prior to the ring
process.
5. When a Hunt group has guaranteed announcement (the 1st announcement timer is set to 0),
Overflow timer is stated and ring is provided after the announcement is completely played.
6. Only the 1st announcement may be used for guaranteed announcement.
7. If all stations in the group are busy when a call is received, the call continues to wait for an
available station in the group. If queued, the call may be sent to MOH until the call is answered or
disconnected.
8. If there is no available member in a group because every member sets DND, UCD DND, or call
forward, all new calls to the group and all queued calls in the group are rerouted to another
destination. One of the following is determined as to destination in the listed order;
a. Overflow destination if assigned.
b. Alternative destination if the group is UCD group and it is assigned.
9. If a call is not answered until Overflow Timer expires, it will be sent to overflow destination while
the VMIB announcement is being played.
10. If overflow destination is not assigned, the call will be dropped when overflow timer expires.
11. If an Announcement Timer is set and no VMIB number is assigned, the announcement is ignored.
12. When the number of queued incoming calls are over the pre-defined in UCD group, the incoming
CO calls will be dropped. If alternative destination is set and all members are busy, incoming calls
are not queued. All calls are routed to alternative destination. If overflow destination is
programmed, the queued call is re-routed to overflow destination after overflow timer is expired.
13. Pick-up Hunt group is for only intercom call.
14. ISDN phone can be a member of Hunt group. But, it only works for answering a hunt call.
15. Group pick-up doesn’t work with a call of Hunt group pilot number. While trying to do it, you will
hear error tone.
16. ISDN phone can not be the first hunt group member. And two number entrance for one ISDN
phone does not permit.
Reference
1. Recording System VMIB Announcement : 2.11.1
2. ICM Box Music Selection : 2.13.10
Admin Programming
Hunt group Assign 4.7.1 (PGM 190)
Hunt group Attribute 4.7.2 (PGM 191)
2.6.2 Terminal Group
Calls to a station in the group or a pilot number will go to the first station in the group. If unanswered
100
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
or unavailable, the call proceeds to the next listed station in the group. The call will continue to be
rerouted until reaching the last station in the group where the call will remain or can be sent to an
overflow station/group. A terminal Hunt group can be assigned with a pilot number (Hunt group
number) and only calls to the pilot number will hunt.
[Example]
CO
LINE 1 STA111
Hunt Group Call
(1st)
STA112
STA110
CO Hunt Group Call
LINE 2 (2nd) STA113
STA115
STA114
In Circular Hunt, calls to a station in the group or a pilot number will go to the station or an idle station
101
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
in the group. If unavailable or unanswered in the hunt no answer time, the call is directed to the next
station in the group. The call will continue to route until each station in the group has been tried. The
call will remain at the last station in the group or will be passed to the assigned overflow station or the
assigned overflow group. A circular Hunt group can be assigned with a pilot number (Hunt group
number) and only calls to the pilot number will hunt.
[Example]
STA112
STA115
STA114
All the stations in the group receive ring simultaneously for a call of Hunt group until one of stations
received ring answers the call. If call is not answered until overflow timer, it will be sent to an overflow
102
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
destination, if assigned.
[Example]
CO
LINE 1 Hunt Group Call
(1st) STA111
STA112
This group is assigned for voice mail and only SLT can be assigned as a member of Hunt group.
Calling VM group, the system will search an idle member in the calling VM group with Terminal type or
Circular type.
Calls are sent to the group by dialing the pilot number (Hunt group Number) or assigning CO lines to
directly terminate to the group. Calls are directed to the station in the group that has been idle for the
103
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
longest time. If all stations in the group are busy when a call is received for the group, the call may be
routed to an alternate location, or may continue to wait (queue) for an available station in the group.
Based on programming, the queued call may be taken out of the group and directed to an overflow
station.
The member of UCD group can assign DND. The station assigned UCD-DND will not receive ring.
To assign UCD-DND button,
[TRANS/PGM] + Flex. BTN + [TRANS/PGM] + 8 7 + Hunt Group No. + [HOLD/SAVE]
[Example]
CO
Hunt Group Call
LINE 1 (1st) STA111
STA112
STA110
CO Hunt Group Call
LINE 2 (2nd) STA113
STA115
STA114
CO
LINE 3 Hunt Group Call
(3rd)
Condition
LDK system supports the VMIB announcements for hunt group. And when a call is arrived to
secondary VMIB announcements, caller can be connected another station by the entered number
with CCR service. (PGM 228)
Description
A separate supervisor or common supervisor can be assigned in UCD group. And, the supervisor can
104
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
monitor the status of the group. When a call is queued to a group for longer than a predefined time or
when a predefined number of calls are queued, the supervisor's LCD will indicate the number of calls
in queue, and the queued time for the longest queue. The supervisor can change overflow destination
and timing. The system will provide traffic (see Ref.1) and on line status reports, based on the
supervisor's request for the UCD group including the following group statistics:
- Total calls
- Number of unanswered calls
- Average and the longest queued calls
- Number and total time when all agents are busy
- Average ringing time before answer
- Average service time after answer
Operation
To monitor an agent's conversation at ACD supervisor,
1. Call the busy agent and receive busy tone.
2. Press {ACD} flexible button.
3. The supervisor can monitor the agent, but will not send audio to the agent.
Condition
1. The user should assign a flexible button for {ACD}.
[TRANS/PGM] + Flex. BTN + [TRANS/PGM] + 8 + ACD Group No + [HOLD/SAVE]
2. The user can see the group status by ACD supervisor or by printing periodically to RS-232C print.
3. To print ACD statistics periodically, set the ACD Print Timer (PGM 161-FLEX 10: 10sec base).
4. The agents can also print and view the ACD statistics as the supervisor.
5. The agent can login and logout using Hot Desk feature.
Reference
1. Traffic Analysis : 2.18
Admin Programming
Hunt group Assign 4.7.1 (PGM 190)
Hunt group Program 4.7.2 (PGM 191)
ACD Print Enable 4.4.2.9 (PGM 161 – FLEX 9)
ACD Print Timer 4.4.2.10 (PGM 161 – FLEX 10)
ACD Clear Database after Print 4.4.2.11 (PGM 161 – FLEX 11)
105
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Supervisor Supervisor
CO
CO
or
or
CO
CO
or or or
or
CO CO
Operation
To establish an Add-on Conference,
1. With established the first call, press the [CONF] button. The existing call is on hold and intercom
dial tone is heard.
2. Make a call to internal party.
3. When answered, press the [CONF] button.
4. When all parties have been called, press the [CONF] button again. And all parties can converse.
106
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
1. In unsupervised conference, it is restricted to Unsupervised Conference timer if there is no internal
station in the conference. (Default: 10min.)
2. The Unsupervised Conference timer will be reset if the internal party re-enters the conference.
3. Max. 3 parties (internal/external) can enter a conference in IP LDK-20. But 3 parties can be
members for conference.
4. In Multi-line conference, max. 2 CO lines can make a conference with one internal party.
5. If the supervisor in a conference receives error or busy tone from the internal party while making a
conference, he can receive intercom dial tone again by pressing the [CONF] button.
Admin Programming
Unsupervised Conference Timer 4.5.3.6 (PGM 182 – FLEX 6)
Multi-line Conference 4.4.1.9 (PGM 160 – FLEX 9)
Description
A single line telephone user can initiate a 3-way conference with any combination of CO line or internal
users.
A single line telephone user can alternate between two calls maintaining private conversations with
both parties. The parties may be either internal (stations connected to the system) or external CO line
calls, and may be incoming or outgoing.
Operation
To set up a conference from SLT,
1. Make the first call.
2. Press and release hook switch and intercom dial tone will be heard. The existing call is placed
on exclusive hold and the recall timer is activated.
3. Place the second call and announce conference.
4. Press and release hook switch and you will be connected to the first call.
5. Within 2 seconds, press hook switch to establish a conference.
Condition
1. If you make hook-flash after 2 seconds, brokers call will be initiated.
Description
107
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
During the Paging by conference page zone(at this manual, Paging means broadcast to pre-assigned
destination), second originator can page with first originator together. It is possible for any paged
station user to be the second page originator by off-hook and pressing the [CONF] button. SLT users
might make Hook flash and dial conference join code(58).
At that time, if another second page originator exist, then the previous second originator goes to idle
status and the new second originator can page with the first originator.
Operation
During the conference Page is being activated
Keyset user.
Lift handset and press [CONF] button.
SLT user.
Lift handset to answer the page.
Hook flash and dial conference page join code(58).
Condition
1. Page Timer is not applied to Paging Conference Group.
2. If there is the second page originator, it is impossible to “Meet Me Page”.
3. If the first originator goes on-hook, the conference group paging connection is released.
4. The second originator can make paging regardless of page access privilege.
Admin Programming
Paging Warning Tone 4.4.2.4 (PGM 161 – FLEX 4)
Paging Access 4.1.2.8 (PGM 111 – FLEX 8)
Conference Page Zone 4.1.10 (PGM 119)
SLT Conference Page Join Code. (PGM109-FLEX 5)
Description
This feature allows internal users or CO callers to join a conference without being invited by the
conference supervisor. This conference feature has the conference join codes, and each
conference room has an own join code (room number). A DID and transferred CO call can be a
member of conference. This feature terminates only when deactivation code is dialed.
Operation
To Activate a conference room
(1). Press the [PGM] + 4 + 3 + Room Number (1~9)
108
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
1. The Maximum number of conference room is 9.
2. Up to Maximum 3 members can enter each room. (Same present conference feature)
3. Assigning and entering PASSWORD is Optional.
4. CONF ROOM status can be checked by ATD. (How many members are joining the conference
room)
5. For CO party, only ISDN line can enter a conference room. LCO line cannot be a member of
conference room.
6. If system attendant has a conference room button, she can check the status of conference room
with LED;
ON – Conference room is activated, but there is no member..
OFF – The conference room is deactivated.
Flash 60 IPM – The number of members are 1 to 3.
Admin
Description
Stations can individually be allowed or denied the ability to make pages. This applies to all internal
109
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
zone paging and all external zone paging. A station denied access to paging may still answer a Meet-
Me Page announcement.
There is one External Paging Zone available. External paging requires an externally provided amplifier
and paging system. External page can have a relay contact associated to it.
There are ten internal paging zones available. A station can be in any or all zones or in no zone at all.
Stations not assigned to a page group can still make page announcements, if allowed in station
programming. Stations can be assigned to a page group in order to receive pages but not allowed to
make page announcements.
Stations to receive pages for a given zone are assigned to the zone. A page warning tone, if assigned,
will be provided to the page zone(s) prior to the audio connection. The user is allowed to continue the
page for a specified period. After the time is expired, the user is disconnected and the page zone(s) is
returned to idle.
A user can respond to a page from any station and connect to the paging party for a private
conversation. The user should respond to the page in the Page Time-out duration to connect the
paging party.
Paging Code:
Access Code ITEM
501-510 Internal Page Zone
506-510:Conference page zone
543 Internal All Call Page
544 Meet Me Page
545 External Page Zone
549 All Call Page (Internal & External)
Operation
To make a page,
1. Lift the handset or press the [MON] button.
2. Dial the desired paging code.
3. If assigned, after page warning tone, make announcement.
4. Replace the handset and go on-hook.
Condition
1. When external paging is required, appropriate external equipment should be attached to the
proper external page connections on the MBU.
2. A station which is in DND or busy, it cannot receive a page.
3. A station which is not allowed to page cannot make a page.
4. When a paging is used in the system, another paging is not allowed.
5. Page warning tone may be controlled by Admin. Programming.
110
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
6. When the page timer is expired, paging connection is automatically released and ICM busy tone
is presented to the paging station.
7. You should lift the handset to make a page. When trying to make a page without lifting handset,
“LIFT HANDSET TO PAGE” is displayed on the LCD.
8. Paging can be programmed to a Flex. button.
9. If an intercom call is received to the paging station, the caller will hear intercom busy tone.
10. If a CO line call is received to the paging station, the station will receive off-hook ring.
Meet-me Page
1. To assign {MEET-ME PAGE} at a flexible button,
[TRANS/PGM] + Flex. BTN + 5 4 4 + [HOLD/SAVE]
2. A station may respond meet me page regardless of assignment of pick-up/paging group
assignment/page access.
3. Page from CO line can’t be answered by pressing the [HOLD/SAVE] button or the code of
meet-me answer. If a user tries to answer a meet me page request from CO line, error tone is
heard and LCD message for error will be displayed.
Admin Programming
Paging Timeout Timer 4.5.2.10 (PGM 181 – FLEX 10)
Page Warning Tone 4.4.2.4 (PGM 161 – FLEX 4)
Page Access 4.1.2.8 (PGM 111 – FLEX 8)
Internal Page Zone 4.1.9 (PGM 118)
External Control Contact 4.4.9 (PGM 168)
Description
User can record VMIB message for paging.
Operation
To record VMIB paging message,
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Dial 6 5.
3. You will hear the announcement “Press # button to record” If there is already a recorded
message in the number dialed, the recorded message will be played.
4. Dial # to start recording. Start the recording after hearing the announcement “Record your
message” and confirmation tone.
5. Press the [HOLD/SAVE] button or the [MON] button to finish the recording. Then confirmation
tone is heard.
6. Pressing the [SPEED] button while playing, then the announcement is deleted and confirmation
tone is heard.
111
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
1. You should lift handset to make a page.
2. If there is any recorded message, it is paged and if there is no recorded message, user’s voice is
paged.
Admin Programming
Paging Timeout Timer 4.5.2.10 (PGM 181 – FLEX 10)
Description
The system allows of being recorded multiple VMIB messages for pre-recorded paging. Depending on
circumstance, user can use pre-recorded messages for paging. Recorded VMIB message is paged to
a page zone at emergency.
Operation
To assign {VMIB SOS Paging} at a flexible button,
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Press a flexible button to assign.
3. Dial paging code (5xx).
4. Dial Message number (001~070)
5. Press the [HOLD/SAVE] button.
Condition
1. This feature can be only activated by pressing assigned flexible button on a DKTU in idle state.
2. The VMIB message for SOS Paging can be recorded only at attendant station.
3. Paging zone includes internal, external and all call paging area.
4. VMIB SOS paging is not restricted by VMIB Paging timer. The whole VMIB SOS paging can be
paged even though Paging Timeout timer expires.
112
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
The figure 2.9.1 describes that there is CO call to executive station in Executive/Secretary pairs,
1 ) if executive station is idle, executive station will receive the ring of the CO call.
2 ) if executive station is busy or in DND, designated secretary station will receive the ring of the
CO call.
Operation
To activate Executive/Secretary Transfer from the Executive's DKTU,
Press the [DND/FOR] button.
Condition
1. Secretary can pass a call to Executive when in DND state(see Ref.1) by using camp-on
feature(see Ref.2).
2. One Executive can have multiple Secretaries within maximum pairs, and one secretary can be
assigned to multiple executives within maximum pairs.
3. When the executive is in DND, the secretary can transfer a CO line call or make camp-on.(see
Ref.3)
4. It is possible to make a chain to assign Executive/Secretary pairs. It means that a Secretary may
be an Executive of another Executive/Secretary pair. If an Executive and the Secretary which has
own Secretary are busy, a call will be forwarded to the second Secretary of Executive/Secretary
113
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Reference
1. DND : 2.4.9
2. Camp-On : 2.4.5
3. Call transfer : 2.3.2
4. Call forward : 2.3.1
Admin Programming
Do Not Disturb 4.1.2.3 (PGM 111 – FLEX 3)
Executive/Secretary Transfer 4.11.3 (PGM 229)
Description
Two stations can be linked with each other by programming. Linking with a DKTU and a wireless
terminal(DECT), the user can use them alternatively. When two stations are linked, the following
functions are supported;
114
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
[Example]
Linked Pair
Figure 2.9.2 Ringing in Linked-Pair when two linked stations are idle.
CO Busy state
LINE
STA 110
STA 110
The figure 2.9.2 describes that if two linked stations in Linked-Pair are idle and a CO call arrives, two
linked stations ring. But the figure 2.9.3 describes that if one linked station in Linked-Pair is busy and
a new CO call arrives, the caller will hear the busy tone.
¾ If one of two linked stations receives intercom calls/CO incoming calls (DISA/DID)/recall
ring(system/exclusive hold / transfer), then the other linked station will receive ring together.(see
Ref.1, Ref.2)
¾ If one station of linked pair goes to DND or call forward or pre-selected message display
state(see Ref.3, Ref.4), then linked station goes to the same state automatically. Also, if any
station in a linked pair comes out of this state, then the other comes out simultaneously.
¾ If one of linked stations is busy, the LCD of the other station will display “IN USE AT LINK STA”.
¾ When a linked station is busy, the other idle linked station will not receive ring for CO lines,
transferred ring or intercom calls.
115
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
1. It is available to make 13 linked station pairs.
2. A station can be linked with only one station.
3. The intercom number of two linked stations is operated as one number for all features.
4. The presented number of linked pair is the first station number (Master) which is assigned by
Admin Programming.
5. The station attributes of the second station (Slave) will follow the attributes of Master’s. (Ex.
Day/Night COS, CO Warning Tone, CO Auto Hold, CO Call Drop, Alarm…)
6. intercom box, DSS/DLS or ISDN phone cannot be linked with a station.
7. It is operated with Tone mode in linked station pair regardless of intercom Answer mode(STA
program 1 2).
8. Attendant station can be linked with the other station. But, the linked station cannot use attendant
features(see Ref.5).
9. A linked station can call his pair station by dialing his own number. It is possible to make CO
line/Intercom Transfer between two pairs.
Reference
1. HOLD : 2.3.3
2. Call transfer : 2.3.2
3. DND : 2.4.9
4. Call forward : 2.3.1
5. Attendant : 2.13
Admin Programming
Linked Station Pairs 4.4.20 (PGM 179)
Description
Maximum 2 relays in IP LDK-20 can be used for Door Open feature.
116
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Operation
1. Dial the door open code, or press the programmed {DOOR OPEN} button.
To Registered Door Open
[TRANS/PGM] + FLEX button(to be assigned) + #*1 (1st Door open) + [HOLD/SAVE]
Admin Programming
Door Open 4.1.3.22 (PGM 112 – FLEX 22)
External Control Contact 4.4.9 (PGM 168)
Door Open Timer 4.5.2.5 (PGM 181 – FLEX 5)
Description
A convenient intercom box can be connected to the system. The intercom box can receive page
announcements and intercom calls. And the intercom box can signal assigned stations in the system.
Any combination of DKTUs or intercom boxes can be arranged in the system.
[Example]
ICM BOX
(Door Phone) Reception
Reception Call
Conversation
Call Button
Door Open(2.10.1)
Door
Operation
To call an intercom box,
1. Lift the handset or press the [MON] button.
2. Dial station number of intercom box or press the flexible button for the intercom box.
3. After warning tone, announce the call.
117
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
1. While hearing music at intercom box, press the [DND] button to stop the music.
2. intercom Box cannot attend a conference(see Ref.2).
3. The CO call is not received at intercom box.
4. An intercom box can be a member of page zone group(see Ref.3).
5. To receive intercom box call at SLT, set intercom Box Signaling value to ON (ADMIN program 111–
FLEX 6). If Nation code is TELKOM or ISRAEL, DSS button for ICM Box should be assigned to
SLT (ADMIN program 115).
6. SLT can receive only one call from intercom box.
Reference
1. DND : 2.4.9
2. Conference : 2.7
3. Paging : 2.8
Admin Programming
ICM Box Signaling 4.1.2.6 (PGM 111 – FLEX 6)
Station ID Assignment 4.1.1 (PGM 110)
ICM Box Music Channel 4.4.12.3 (PGM 171 – FLEX 3)
ICM Box Timer 4.5.2.6 (PGM 181 – FLEX 6)
Description
The LBC(Loud Bell Control) contacts are activated when the assigned station receives ringing from an
incoming CO line (if assigned ring), transferred CO line, or intercom call.
Condition
1. Two LBC contacts can be assigned individually to the station. All the contacts may be assigned to
the same station but, only the first contact will be activated in the intercom call.
2. The LBC 1 can be programmed to be operated as an external night ring contact as well as a LBC
contact.
3. In the night mode, LBC 1 will follow UNA(see Ref.1) ring assignment and will ignore the station
ring.
4. An external ringing device should be attached to the contacts.
118
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Reference
1. UNA(Universal Night Answer) : 2.1.7
Admin Programming
External Night Ring 4.1.1.7 (PGM 160 – FLEX 7)
Universal Night Answer 4.2.2.8 (PGM 141 – FLEX 8)
External Control Contacts 4.4.9 (PGM 168)
Description
Attendant station in the system can record the voice announcements as system greetings and prompts.
System greetings should be recorded before use.
System prompts in user’s language are contained as default in VMIB. But users can also modify those
prompts.
Prompts for date and time are contained in VMIB to be used for date and time stamping. With the help
of these prompts, users can understand when the voice message has arrived. Prompts for date and
time are also built-in and recorded in user’s language.
Operation
To record system greetings from Attendant;
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button and dial 0 6.
2. Dial the message number. Then you will hear the announcement “Press # button to record” If
there is already a recorded message in the number dialed, the recorded message will be played.
3. Dial # to start recording. Start the recording after hearing the announcement “Record your
message” and confirmation tone.
4. Or, dial * to record using external music port on the MBU.
5. Press the [HOLD/SAVE] button to finish recording. Then confirmation tone is heard and you can
record the next one.
6. Pressing the [MON] button while recording, then the recording is stopped and the recorded
message is saved.
119
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
No Messages
071 VMIB MOH
072 Reserved
073 Invalid Number Prompt
074 Time Out Prompt
075 Retry Prompt
076 Transfer to Attendant Prompt
077 Reserved
078 Leave Message Prompt
079 Record Start Prompt
080 Authorization Code Prompt
081 Busy Prompt
082 Reserved
083 Station Off-net Forward Prompt
084 DND Prompt
085 No Answer Prompt
086 Reserved
087 Reserved
088 Remote VMIB Control Main Menu Prompt
089 Remote VMIB Sub-menu for digit 1 in Main Menu
090 Reserved
091 Reserved
092 Reserved
093 Remote VMIB Sub-menu for digit 2 in Main Menu
094 Remote VMIB Sub-menu for digit 3 in Main Menu
095 Remote VMIB Sub-menu for digit * in Main Menu
096 Leave Message after Tone Prompt
097 Message waiting indication Prompt
098 Default User Greeting Prompt
099~100
Condition
1. System Greetings message are 001~070 as default value. User can select one of 70 messages.
2. System Prompt messages are 071~100 as default value. The number is message and user cannot
change the numbering plan arbitrarily, but users can also modify those prompts by recording their
own messages in the number.
3. System greetings and prompts can be recorded only at system attendant station.
4. There is no time limit to record system greetings and prompts at attendant station.
5. If the VMIB is not installed in the system, it is impossible to record system greetings and prompts.
Error tone will be heard.
6. If there is a recorded message in the bin, the already recorded message is played when user dials
the message number.
7. If user stops recording by pressing the [MON] button or on-hook the receiver while recording, the
already recorded message is saved. User should delete the recorded message to cancel the
recording.
8. To record or delete a message at attendant station, all the VMIB ports should be idle state.
9. When a call is transferred to the attendant, ‘Transfer to Attendant’ Prompt will be provided to the
caller and ring-back tone will be heard after the announcement.
10. If there is no recorded greetings or prompts, the corresponding tone will be heard.
11. Max. 2000 user messages are available in a VMIB.
120
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
12. It is possible to use only 100 messages for system greetings (system greetings, system prompt,
VMIB MOH).
13. If you use VMIB MOH as the source of system MOH, a port of VMIB should be always reserved
for MOH though MOH is not used now.
14. Only 1 VMIB MOH can be recorded on a VMIB.
15. When the memory is full while recording a system greeting, the recorded message before
message full will be saved.
16. It is available for station groups to have different system greetings.
17. When recording system greetings and prompts at attendant station, they will be saved at all VMIB
in the system except VMIB MOH.
18. User can record the VMIB MOH with system prompt message number ‘071’.
19. The system supports system prompts (072~100) basically. But users may use their own prompts
by recording the prompts at attendant station.
Admin Programming
VMIB Access 4.1.4.2 (PGM 113 – FLEX 2)
VMIB User Record Timer 4.5.2.3 (PGM 181 – FLEX 3)
VMIB Valid User Message Timer 4.5.2.4 (PGM 181 – FLEX 4)
Station Group Attribute Assign 4.7.1 (PGM 190) / 4.7.2 (PGM 191)
Description
An outside caller through DID/DISA(see Ref.1) can access VMIB after calling a station which is in
VMIB Forward mode. Entering VMIB controlling mode, the user can retrieve received messages,
change user greeting, release Call Forward to VMIB , etc.
Operation
To enter Remote VMIB Control mode,
1. Dial the station number which is forwarded to VMIB from external party with DID/DISA.
2. User greeting is heard.
3. While user greeting is played, press * key.
4. “Enter your password” is heard.
5. Enter the password (authorization code) and ‘#’ (end mark of authorization code. If 5 Digits
authorization mode, ‘#’ is no need.).
6. “Listed messages xx” is heard. (xx: the number of listed messages)
7. Press the appropriate dial number with the followings;
- Dial 1 to retrieve the received voice messages
- Dial 2 to listen or change user greeting
- Dial 3 to release Call Forward to VMIB mode
- Dial * to exit remote VMIB Control mode
121
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Reference
1. DID : 2.1.3
2. DISA : 2.1.4
Condition
1. Pressing * key while operating in a sub-menu, the system will go to the main control menu.
2. If the user doesn’t enter any digit while Inter-digit time, the connection is dropped automatically.
3. If VMIB User Record Timer expires while recording user greeting, the recording is finished and will
go to main menu.
Admin Programming
VMIB User Record Timer 4.5.2.3 (PGM 181 – FLEX 3)
Inter-digit Timer 4.5.2.8 (PGM 181 – FLEX 8)
Description
This feature allows a station to record a conversation on the mailbox by pressing a {RECORD} button
while the station is talking with CO party.
122
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Operation
To set a flexible button programmed for 2-way record feature,
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Dial flexible button(to be assigned).
3. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button and dial ‘54’.
4. Press the [HOLD/SAVE] button.
While a station user is the conversation with the CO line caller, the user press the {RECORD} button,
then the conversation will be recorded on user’s mailbox. The user press the {RECORD} button again
or hang up, then the recording will be canceled.
Protocol;
When user press the {RECORD} button, system send SMDI message for this feature to Voice Mail PC
through RS-232C cable. The format is same as follows.
=>”crlfMD0010mmmmH0xxxxxxxxxbbcrlf^Y”
cr : carriage return,
lf : line feed,
mmmm : VM port number,
H : Action code for recording,
xxxxxxxxx : extension which try to record,
b : ascii space.
Condition
1. During the recording feature is enabled, the {RECORD} button will flash at 240 ipm and if it
is disabled, the {RECORD} button will be extinguished.
2. It is not available to SLT.
3. Recording operation is canceled when station goes off-hook, press {RECORD} button again,
press [FLASH] button or CO party hangs up.
4. This feature is available on SMDI mode only not DTMF mode.
5. Not available to intercom call recording.
6. If the system has VMIB, the conversation will be recorded to VMIB.
Admin Programming
Two Way Recording 4.1.3.10 (PGM112 – FLEX 10)
Description
This feature allows a station to record a conversation on the mailbox by pressing a {RECORD} button
while the station is talking with CO party.
[Example]
LDK System
(Press Record button)
CO Incoming Call 123
Conversation
STA A
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Operation
To set a flexible button programmed for 2-way record feature,
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Dial flexible button(to be assigned).
3. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button and dial ‘54’.
4. Press the [HOLD/SAVE] button.
While a station user is the conversation with the CO line caller, the user press the {RECORD} button,
then the conversation will be recorded on user’s mailbox. The user presses the {RECORD} button
again or hangs up, then the recording will be canceled.
Condition
1. During the recording feature is enabled, the {RECORD} button will flash at 240 ipm and if it is
disabled, the {RECORD} button will be extinguished.
2. Not available to SLT.
3. Recording operation is canceled when station goes off-hook, press {RECORD} button again, press
[FLASH] button or CO party hangs up.
4. Not available to intercom call recording.
5. If the system has an external voice mail system, the conversation will be recorded to the external
voice mail system.
Admin Programming
Two Way Recording 4.1.3.10 (PGM 112 – FLEX 10)
Description
If the access to the VMIB is allowed, user can record User Greeting and make a call be forwarded to
124
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
VMIB port according to forward condition type if user enables forward. And the caller can leave a voice
message wait at the station after hearing user greeting.
125
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
7. Pressing the [REWIND] soft button, you can rewound the current message with VM MSG
Rewind Timer. ((It can be possible LDP-6000/7000 which has 3 soft key.))
Condition
1. There is no time limit to record user greeting in a station.
2. When a caller leaves a voice message wait, the recording time is controlled by Valid User
Message Timer (ADMIN program 181 – FLEX 4) and VMIB User Record Timer (ADMIN program
181 – FLEX 3). When the recorded message shorter than Valid User Message time, the message
is not saved. Also, the User Record Timer expires, confirmation tone is heard and the message is
saved in the station.
3. If the station has several messages to be retrieved by pressing the [CALLBK] button, the
message only with station number will be retrieved at first. (Message wait with station number ->
VMIB Message wait -> CLI Message wait -> VM group Message wait)
4. Pressing the [CALLBK] button at the calling station before user greeting is played, the message
wait with only station number is saved in the called station.
5. When a user calls a station which is forwarded to VMIB, he will hear user greeting and beep tone.
After beep tone, user can leave a voice message.
6. Each station may has max.2000 VMIB message waits.
7. If all the VMIB ports are busy, ring-back tone will be provided instead of user greeting. And VMIB
Station Forward Timer is started to retry to answer.
8. User can leave and receive message wait using SLT with message wait lamp.
9. Individual user greeting and VMIB message wait are protected with system reset.
10. To retrieve left message wait, the order of playing is changeable. Originally, TIME, DATE, and a
left message are played. If the ADMIN is set, DATE, TIME, and a left message are played.
11. To retrieve left message wait, the Message Wait Retrieve Password would be used by ADMIN. If
ADMIN PGM 113 & FLEX 8 is set, a user should enter that stations’ AUTHORIZE CODE to
retrieve.
12. When user listen to the message, user can rewind the message. Rewound Time is controlled by
Rewind Message Timer (PGM 181 – Flex 17)
Reference
1. Message Wait/Callback Return Code : 3.2.7(ADMIN 106 – FLEX 17)
Admin Programming
VMIB Message Type 4.1.2.17 (PGM 111 – FLEX 17)
VMIB Access 4.1.4.2 (PGM 113 – FLEX 2)
VMIB MSG Retrieve PASSWORD 4.1.4.8 (PGM 113 – FLEX 8)
VMIB MSG Retrieve Date/Time 4.1.4.9 (PGM 113 – FLEX 9)
VMIB Forward No Answer Timer 4.5.2.1 (PGM 181 – FLEX 1)
VMIB User Record Timer 4.5.2.3 (PGM 181 – FLEX 3)
VMIB Valid User Message Timer 4.5.2.4 (PGM 181 – FLEX 4)
VMIB Message Rewind Timer 4.5.2.17 (PGM 181 – FLEX 17)
126
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
Incoming CO calls may be answered by VMIB and rerouted to another station with CCR when
attendant does not answer the call until No Answer Timer expires or attendant is busy.
Operation
To operate Auto Attendant,
1. When an incoming call is received at attendant,
2. The call is not answered until No Answer Timer expires by attendant or attendant is busy.
3. The call is forwarded to Auto attendant. The caller will hear VMIB message and can reroute the
other user with CCR.
Condition
1. It is for no answered incoming call and not available for recall and transferred call.
2. To use Auto attendant feature, CO ring should be assigned to only attendant.
Admin Programming
Auto Attendant VMIB Announce # 4.4.6 (PGM 165)
Description
The received message in a station may be transferred to the other station.
Operation
To transfer a message to the other station,
1. While hearing a message, dial the station number to be transferred.
2. The message will be transferred to the station.
Condition
1. If a transferring station is empty, user will hear error tone and can retry to the other station within 3
seconds.
2. SLT with MSG wait lamp can also transfer VMIB messages.
3. The transferred station should have allowance of VMIB access.
Admin Programming
VMIB Access 4.1.4.2 (PGM 113 – FLEX 2)
127
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
The LDK System SMDR(station message detail recording) provides details information about both
incoming calls and outgoing calls. In this feature, it is programmable to record all calls or just outgoing
long distance calls. SMDR information includes outgoing CO Line, dialed number, time, date, station
that answer the call, duration of call and etc. Authorization codes may also be entered and recorded.
Maximum 1000 of SMDR data can be recorded at system memory.
[Example]
LDK System
DKTU PORT
Attendant
RS-232C
The figure 2.12.1 describes that there are LDK system, PC, attendant station as elements of SMDR
and LDK system connects with Attendant through DKTU port and with PC through RS-232C.
Operation
To print SMDR,
1. Activate PC utility program on PC.
2. Connect serial port of MPB to the serial port of PC with the cable of RS-232C.
3. At the attendant station, press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
4. At the attendant station, dial 0111 (Station Base) or 0113 (Group Base).
5. At the attendant station, enter the station or group range.
6. The SMDR is printed to PC.
To delete SMDR,
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Dial 0112 (Station Base) or 0114 (Group Base).
Condition
1. There is an assignable SMDR record option ADMIN program(PGM177 – FLEX 3). If SMDR –
LONG DISTANCE ONLY is selected, only outgoing toll call will be printed, and If SMDR – ALL
CALL is selected, incoming and outgoing local and long distance call are printed.
2. If user dials any number with a programmed long distance code as the first and second digit dialed
or any number with more than maximum local call digit count, it will be regarded as long distance
128
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
call. (Max. local call digit count is programmable and the default value is 7.)
3. The SMDR output records contain the followings;
- 5-digit station call originator (terminating for incoming) filed
- 3-digit used CO line field
- 8-digit call duration field (HH:MM:SS)
- 8-digit year, month, and day (YY/MM/DD)
- 5-digit time of day call originator field
- 1 digit call identification digit-first digit in digit dial field
- 18-digit collected dial digit field
- 2-digit account group number field
- 5-digit pulse metering count field
- 10-digit call cost field
- 12-digit account code field
4. When the SMDR storage pools are almost exhausted, the system gives “Buffer full” warning signal
to the attendant. And the LCD of attendant station will indicate how many SMDR records are
remained to store for some intervals.
5. Some stations can be grouped to count the billing with a SMDR receipt using a SMDR account
group.
6. ‘SLT DTMF RLS TMR’ should be adjusted to reasonable value in order to print all digits that SLT
dialed.
Admin Programming
SMDR Attribute 4.4.18 (PGM 177)
Metering Unit 4.2.3.3 (PGM 142 – FLEX 3)
SLT DTMF RLS Timer 4.5.2.13 ( PGM 181 – FLEX 13)
Description
The AOC service provides outgoing call charging to the user in public ISDN. According to the ADMIN
programming, the saved and printed information is provided to the PC or user's LCD. This function is
applicable to the most European countries.
Operation
During the conversation or after release a CO call, the ISDN facility IE carry the AOC information. User
can see it with SMDR print after a call.
* FREE OF CHARGE
al 0a 02 01 ** 02 01 23 30 02 81 00
* NORMAL CHARGING
al 20 02 01 ** 02 01 23 30 18 30 16 al 05
81 03 @@ @@ @@ a2 07 81 05 %% %% %% %% %%
82 01 01 82 01 01
[**] : The rule is changed in each call.
129
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
1. It is displayed on the LCD instead of call timer and changed based on the receipt of each call
charging information.
2. The information of AOC includes the Unit or Currency.
Admin Programming
Advice Of Charge 4.8.1.1 (PGM 200 – FLEX 1)
SMDR Attribute 4.4.18 (PGM 177)
2.12.2 Print-out
Description
Lost call means that the caller gives up and terminates the call before the call is answered. The format
of the individual call record is illustrated below, and the contents are focused on each case about the
types of lost call.
z G: Incoming call to hunt group(see Ref.1), but the caller hangs up before answer
z H: Answered incoming call was transferred to another station, but the caller hangs up before
answer. And incoming call placed on hold state and cleared down in hold state.
z R: Direct call (DID) to a station, but the call was disconnected before the station answers. Or
direct call to station (A), but station (A) does not answer and the call was forwarded to station
(B). The call was disconnected before station (B) answers.
Operation
To print the lost call count of record,
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Dial 0117 at Attendant station.
130
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
3. The lost call count of record is printed in the PC connected in the system.
Condition
1. This SMDR record is sent to RS-232C automatically as soon as the event takes place.
2. The SMDR record about lost call is not saved. Only the records are counted.
3. To activate this SMDR record, the SMDR field must be set in ADMIN programming.
Reference
1. Hunt group : 2.6
Admin Programming
SMDR Print Enable 4.4.18.2 (PGM 177 – FLEX 2)
Long distance/ All Call Recorded 4.4.18.3 (PGM 177 – FLEX 3)
Print Lost Call 4.4.18.6 (PGM 177 – FLEX 6)
An attendant properly controls the incoming calls by transferring calls and accessing the unanswered
calls, etc. And an attendant can change simple setting of whole system or intercom tenancy group
which belongs to. – changing LCD date/time format, etc.
There are 2 types of attendant in the LDK system. The types of attendant and feature of each
attendant type are :
Main Attendant - max. 5 stations can be defined as main attendants. Main attendants control the
whole system. And operation of main attendants effects on whole system. The first main attendant is
called the system attendant. The system attendant can be changed, but can’t be removed.
Intercom tenancy Group Attendant - each intercom tenancy group(see Ref.1) can have its own
attendant. The intercom tenancy group attendant controls the stations belonging to the intercom
tenancy group. And operation of intercom tenancy group attendants can effects on only intercom
tenancy group which belongs to.
Generally, the attendant of a station is the intercom tenancy group attendant which the station belongs
to. If the intercom tenancy group attendant of the station doesn’t exist, the main attendants will supply
the station with attendant services.
131
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
IP LDK System
Main Attendant 1
( System attendant )
STA 101(Default)
Main Attendant 2
STA a
Main Attendant 3
STA b
Main Attendant 4
STA c
Main Attendant 5
STA d
intercom tenancy group
Main Attendant Assignment
The figure 2.13.1 describes the arrangement of attendants of IP LDK-20 system generally.
Reference
1. Intercom tenancy Group : 2.5.15
Description
As default, first station( e.g. station100) is assigned as the system attendant, and other attendants
are not assigned.
Main attendants can be assigned ADMIN program 164, but Intercom tenancy group attendant can be
assigned ADMIN program 120 – FLEX 1.
Reference
1. Intercom tenancy Group : 2.5.15
132
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Admin Programming
Main Attendant Assignment 4.4.5.1 (PGM 164)
Intercom tenancy Group Attendant Assignment 4.1.11.1(PGM 120 – FLEX 1)
Description
Attendant call is the intercom call and CO call to an attendant.
In order to make an intercom call to the attendant, a user enters the station number of the attendant or
dials ‘0’ button.
If a user dials ‘0’ button, it rings at the assigned attendant of the intercom tenancy group which the
station belongs to. If there is no assigned station as attendant, it rings at main attendant.
Call to any attendant will be queued, if the attendant is busy. Then, ring-back tone or MOH(see Ref.2)
will be provided to the calling party.(ADMIN program 160 – FLEX 1)
Operation
To call an attendant,
1. Lift handset or press [MON] button.
2. Dial ‘0’ button or enter the station number of the attendant.
Condition
1. When an attendant calls another attendant which is busy, the calling attendant will hear the busy
tone and can make camp-on(see Ref.3) to called attendant.
2. If attendant activates unconditional call forward(see Ref.4), the calls to attendant will follow the call
forward process.
Reference
1. Intercom tenancy Group : 2.5.15
2. MOH(Music On Hold) : 2.4.17
3. Camp-on : 2.4.5
4. Unconditional Call Forward : 2.3.1.4
Admin Programming
Main Attendant Assignment 4.4.5 (PGM 164)
MOH Type 4.4.12.2 (PGM 171 – FLEX 2)
Intercom Group Attendant Assignment 4.1.11.1 (PGM 120 – FLEX 1)
Attendant Call Queuing RBT/MOH 4.4.1.1 (PGM 160 – FLEX 1)
Description
The attendant can forward (Unconditional Call Forward) a call to the other station.(see Ref.1)
the forwarded-to station will substitute for the attendant temporarily, while the attendant is in forwarding
state.
133
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
The figure 2.13.2 describes that forwarded-to station serves attendant functions during Attendant
Forward.
Operation
It is the same procedure as the Unconditional Call Forward.
Condition
If the attendant assigns unconditional call forward to SLT or WHTU, the forwarded-to station only serve
incoming calls as attendant call, attendant recall and others. The forwarded-to SLT or WHTU cannot
activate attendant features.
Reference
1. Unconditional Call Forward : 2.3.1.4
Description
When an attendant have a urgent message to a station which is conversing with a CO party, the
attendant can intrude upon the conversation and converse with the station and the CO line.
conversation
CO line 134
intrusion
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
conversation
CO line
conversion
conversion
attendant
The figure 2.13.3 describes that the attendant converses with the other two CO party after attendant
intrusion.
Operation
To intrude on a CO call while the attendant is receive intercom busy tone,
z Press the programmed {ATD INTRUSION} FLEX button.
2. After intrusion tone, converse with the CO party.
Condition
1. To assign {ATD INTRUSION} FLEX button,
[TRANS/PGM] + FLEX button ( to be assigned )+ [TRANS/PGM] + 8 6 + [HOLD/SAVE]
2. In order to use this feature, The Auto Privacy should be OFF( ADMIN program 161 – FLEX 5) and
Override Privilege(ADMIN program 113 – FLEX 4) of the attendant should be Enable.
Admin Programming
Auto Privacy 4.4.2.5 (PGM161 – FLEX 5)
Privacy Warning Tone 4.4.2.6 (PGM 161 – FLEX 6)
Override Privilege 4.1.4.4.(PGM 113 – FLEX 4)
Description
A station in DND state(see Ref.1) can not generally receive an incoming call.
The attendant, however, can temporarily invalidate the DND state. Therefore, the attendant can call
and transfer to the station in DND state.
135
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Intercom call,
transfer, etc. DND tone override
The figure 2.13.4 describes that the attendant can call the station in DND state after Attendant
Override.
Operation
-> To override DND state at a station while the attendant is received DND tone,
1. Dial or the last digit of the dialed station number.
Or, press the programmed {Camp-On} FLEX button.
2. DND warning tone will be changed to intercom ring-back tone at attendant.
3. Attendant can call a station in DND state as a normal call.
Condition
1. To assign {Camp-On} FLEX button,
[TRANS/PGM] + FLEX. BTN(to be assigned) + [TRANS/PGM] + 8 5 + [HOLD/SAVE]
2. If the attendant with a transferred CO call overrides a station in DND state, and the station has the
{CO} or {LOOP} button, attendant can transfer the CO call to the station in DND state.
But, If the transferred-to station has no the {CO} or {LOOP} button, the CO call will be recalled to
the attendant immediately.
Reference
1. DND : 2.4.9
Description
If the recalled CO call(transfer, hold) is unanswered by destination station, the CO call will be directed
to the attendant.(see Ref.1,2) This is attendant recall. The attendant will receive the recall ring for a
time equal to the Attendant Recall Timer(ADMIN program 180 – FLEX 1). If the attendant doesn’t
136
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
answer the CO call for a time equal to the Attendant Recall Timer, the CO call will be disconnected.
Condition
1. If the attendant of intercom tenancy group is not assigned, the CO call is recalled to the system
attendant.
2. When a call in exclusive hold is recalled to attendant, the call is changed to a call in system
hold.(see Ref.1)
3. Private CO line will not be recalled to attendant.(see Ref.4)
Reference
1. Hold : 2.3.3.2
2. Call Transfer : 2.3.2
3. Intercom Tenancy Group : 2.5.15
4. Private Line : 2.2.9
Admin Programming
Attendant Recall Timer 4.5.1.1 (PGM 180 – FLEX 1)
I-Hold Recall Timer 4.5.1.5 (PGM 180 – FLEX 5)
Description
The attendant can change the LCD Date/Time display format of stations in system.
Date : MM-DD-YY / DD-MM-YY ( ex. August 4, 2004 -> 08-04-03 / 04-08-03 )
Time : 12H / 24H ( ex. eight thirty P.M. -> 08:30 PM / 20:30 )
Operation
To change LCD Date format (toggle),
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Dial 0 4 4.
Admin Programming
LCD Time Display Mode 4.4.10.1 (PGM 169 – FLEX 1)
LCD Date Display Mode 4.4.10.2 (PGM 169 – FLEX 2)
137
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
When a CO call come in the system, the destination of CO call can be changed according to the time.
Such event is happened because the ring mode can be changed according to the time.
There are 5 ring modes – Day mode/Night mode/Weekend mode/On-demand mode/Automatic Ring
mode. The destination of CO call can be set differently at each ring mode, while a user sets the
destination of CO call with ADMIN program(see Ref.1). At Day mode/Night mode/Weekend mode, the
user set the appropriate destination of CO call according to the situation( day or night or weekend ).
On-demand mode among the ring mode is used to supply a different destination of CO call except Day
mode/Night mode/Weekend mode.
The ring mode in Automatic Ring mode is classified as Day mode or Night mode or Weekend mode
according to Weekly Time Table(ADMIN program 233).
Only attendant can change the ring mode. If a user presses the [DND/FOR] button at the attendant
station, the ring mode will be changed to Day -> On-demand -> Night -> Weekend -> Automatic Ring
mode -> Day in sequence.
Operation
To change Day / On-demand / Night / Weekend / Automatic Ring mode,
1. Whenever pressing the [DND/FOR] button at the attendant station, the ring mode will be
changed to
Day -> On-demand -> Night -> Weekend -> Automatic Ring mode -> Day in sequence.
Condition
1. The default value of Weekly Time Table is as follows( entry number : 00 ). The first table entry (00)
is for main attendants and others (01~15) are for intercom tenancy group attendants.
138
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Reference
1. Ring assignment : 2.1.1
Admin Programming
CO Line Ring Assignment 4.2.5 (PGM 144)
External Control Contact 4.4.9 (PGM 168)
Weekly Time Table 4.11.6 (PGM 233)
Description
The attendant can make a particular CO line out-of-outgoing-service. Then a user can’t make a CO
call through the CO line. Incoming CO call is not affected..
Operation
To set a CO line in/out-of-outgoing service from the attendant,
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Dial 0 7 3.
3. Press the desired {CO line} FLEX button. Confirmation tone will be heard when the status(in or
out-of-outgoing-service) of the selected CO line is changed.
4. Press the [MON] button to return to idle.
Condition
1. Any attendant can use this feature.
2. The LED of {CO line} FLEX button which is out-of-outgoing-service is flashing in attendant station
but lightening in other stations.
3. To release the-out-of-outgoing-service, press the flashing {CO line} FLEX button in attendant
station.
4. Though the desired CO line is busy, the attendant can still make the CO line out-of-outgoing-
service. The out-of-outgoing-service feature will take effect after the CO line goes to idle.
139
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
The attendant can select the music channel source to provide the intercom Box.
Operation
To select the music source from the attendant,
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Dial 0 7 5.
3. Dial the music source (00~12).
And music source will be heard. But if the music channel has no music source, no music is heard
4. Press the [HOLD/SAVE] button.
Reference
1. BGM(Background Music) : 2.4.4
2. MOH(Music On Hold) : 2.4.17
Admin Programming
Intercom Box Music Channel 4.4.12.3 (PGM 171 – FLEX 3)
Description
The attendants can cancel features - such as DND, Call Forward and pre-selected messages - of
other stations.(see Ref.1, Ref.2, Ref.3)
Operation
To disable active features at a station from the attendant,
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Dial 0 7 1.
3. Dial the desired station range.
4. Press the [HOLD/SAVE] button.
Reference
140
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
1. DND : 2.4.9
2. Call Forward : 2.3.1
3. Pre-selected Message : 2.4.1.2
Description
Attendants and other DKTU may be equipped with DSS/DLS consoles which provide additional
buttons for more convenient operation. The consoles are arranged as flexible mapped units. The
DSS/DLS consoles are assigned with programming as one of the 3 maps. All buttons of any map are
programmable.
The DSS/DLS consoles each require a separate line connection to the KSU, and take up a station
number.
Condition
1. There is no limit to the number of DSS/DLS consoles in a system.
2. The default value for DSS/DLS is as follows;
Calling Number and Called Number services are supported. Calling Number services will be routed in
the same way as ANI(automatic number identification) calls using the DID route table .
The rules and conditions of ANI are the same, and still apply to Calling Number service on ISDN lines.
141
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Called Number services will be routed using the DID route table. The rules and conditions of DID and
still apply to ISDN Called Number service on ISDN lines.
Channels
- The bearer channels (B channels) transport voice information to and from the Central
Office.
- The data channel (D channel) controls all signaling information for the bearer channels.
Description
LDK system is supporting ISDN-SS-CD (ISDN Supplementary Service – Call Deflection). The protocol
standard about CD can be referred the ETS 300-202/206/207.
Operation
To activate ISDN-SS-CD about CO lines:
1) In ADMIN program 143, enter CO lines range that serve ISDN-SS CD.
2) Press the flexible button 9, and set ISDN-SS CD field value as ENABLE.
Condition
This feature can be used within only ISDN network that supports ISDN-SS CD service.
Admin Programming
ISDN-SS Call Deflection 4.2.4.9 (PGM 143 – FLEX 9)
Description
The term of CLI is the telephone number of caller. By using of this, LDK station user can recognize the
incoming CO caller’s information and send the telephone number of the caller when he make an
outgoing CO call.
142
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
When a station of LDK system receives an incoming CO call that has a telephone number of the caller,
the station user can see the telephone number of incoming CO caller on LCD of station.
The figure 2.14.1 describes an example of incoming CLI process in LDK system. In the figure, the
outside CO caller defines the CALLING PARTY, and the station of LDK system defines the called party.
The calling party makes a call to LDK system and LDK system receives the CLI of this call as
‘04318502824’. At first step, LDK system check whether the start digits information is matched with the
MY AREA CODE(ADMIN program 200 – FLEX 9). In this example, my area code of ‘0431’ is matched
with the incoming CLI. So, LDK system is removing ‘0431’ automatically from CLI data, and the rest
CLI data is sent to the called party, station 100. The station 100 displays the incoming CLI ‘8502824’
on the LCD, if the ADMIN program of CLI display is set to ON(see Operation.1). If the station 100 has
the same speed dial data as the incoming CLI data ‘8502824’, then the matched speed dial data name
can be displayed on LCD according to the ADMIN program of CLI NAME DISPLAY(see Operation.2).
PGM114-FLEX1 : ON
PGM114-FLEX11 : OFF or ON
LCD of USER A LCD of USER A PGM200-FLEX9 : 0431(My Area Code)
Or
850282 LGE
If speed 001(8502824 - LGE) is programmed.
Calling party
USER A(100) 0431 8502824
ISDN
USER B(101)
Operation
In LDK system, the various operations about the incoming CLI is provided according to the ADMIN
program setting.
1. If the CLIP DISPLAY(ADMIN program 114 – FLEX 1) is set to ON, the incoming CLI is displayed
on station LCD.
2. If the CLI NAME DISPLAY(ADMIN program 114 – FLEX 11) is set to ON, the incoming CLI digit
143
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
display can be replaced to the matched station speed dial data name.
3. If the CLI print(ADMIN program 200 – FLEX 6) is set to ON, the incoming CLI can be printed to
RS-232C port.
4. If the MY AREA CODE(ADMIN program 200 – FLEX 9) is set, and this value is matched with the
start digits of the incoming CLI, then the matched digits are removed automatically.
5. If the MY AREA PREFIX CODE(ADMIN program 200 – FLEX 10) is set, it can be used at the
operation 4 with combination of MY AREA CODE.
6. If the CLI MESSAGE WAIT(ADMIN program 114 – FLEX 4) is set to ON, the unanswered CLI data
will be save at the station memory. (see Ref.1)
Condition
1. Max. 12 digits will be displayed on DKTU as a CLI number.
2. Though the power of system is off, the stored CLI messages is not erased.
3. The CLI can be shown at SLT which has a CLI display LCD in IP LDK-20. But secondary SLT of
2B DKTU can’t display CLI information.
Reference
1. CLI Message Wait : Section 2.14.2.3
Admin Programming
CLIP LCD Display 4.1.5.1 (PGM 114 – FLEX 1)
CLI Name Display 4.1.5.10 (PGM 114 – FLEX 11)
CLI Message Wait 4.1.5.4 (PGM 114 – FLEX 4)
CLI Print 4.8.1.3 (PGM 200 – FLEX 3)
My Area Code 4.8.1.5 (PGM 200 – FLEX 9)
My Area Prefix Code 4.8.1.6 (PGM 200 – FLEX 10)
Description
When a station of LDK system makes an outgoing CO call, it can send the telephone number.
The figure 2.14.2 describes an example of outgoing CLI process in LDK system. In the figure, the
outside CO caller is defined the called party, and the station 100 of LDK system is defined the calling
party. The calling party, station 100, makes an outgoing CO call to the called party, and LDK
generates the CLI of station 100 and transmit it to the called party.
At this example, the CLI of station 100 is ‘04313283100’. This CLI data is combined with three parts.
The start digits of CLI is ‘0431’. It is generated from the MY AREA CODE(ADMIN program 200 –
FLEX 9). The insertion/omission of this value is managed by the CALL TYPE(ADMIN program 143 –
FLEX 3). The end digits of CLI is ‘100’. It generated from the ISDN CLI of station(ADMIN program 114
– FLEX 12). At default, this ADMIN value is set as the same value as the station number. The middle
digits of CLI is ‘3283’. It is generated from the CLIP/COLP TABLE value of CO line(ADMIN program
201, and 143 – FLEX 2).
PGM114-FLEX12 : 100(CLI of Station)
PGM143-FLEX3 : 2(National No.)
PGM200-FLEX9 : 0431(My Area Code)
PGM143-FLEX2 : 00(Index 00 of PGM201)
Calling party PGM201 ENTRY00 : “3283”
144
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Operation
In LDK system, if the CALL TYPE(ADMIN program 143 – FLEX 3) is set to NATIONAL, the outgoing
CLI is generated as illustrated figure 2.14.2, according to the ADMIN program setting.
1. If the ISDN CLI of STATION(ADMIN program 114 – FLEX 12) is set, this value is used as the end
part of CLI when the outgoing CLI is generated.
2. If the MY AREA CODE(ADMIN program 200 – FLEX 9) is set, and this value is used as the first
part of CLI when the outgoing CLI is generated.
3. If the entry of CLIP/COLP TABLE(ADMIN program 201) is set, and if the CLIP TABLE
INDEX(ADMIN program 143 – FLEX 2) is set to the front entry number, then it can be used as the
middle part of CLI when the outgoing CLI is generated.
4. If the CLI RESTRICTION(ADMIN program 114 – FLEX 14) is set to ON, CLI transmission is
restricted.
Condition
1. Though the power of system is off, the stored CLI messages is not erased.
Admin Programming
CLIP/COLP Table 4.8.2 (PGM 201)
CLIP Table Index 4.2.4.2 (PGM 143 – FLEX 2)
Call Type 4.2.4.3 (PGM 143 – FLEX 3)
ISDN CLI of STATION 4.1.5.11 (PGM 114 – FLEX 12)
ISDN CLIR 4.1.5.13 (PGM 114 – FLEX 14)
My Area Code 4.8.1.5 (PGM 200 – FLEX 9)
My Area Prefix Code 4.8.1.6 (PGM 200 – FLEX 10)
2.14.2.3 CLI Message Wait
Description
When a call exists through ISDN DID line, calling line identification (CLI) of the incoming call will be
displayed on the LCD of the station. And if the DID external party hangs up before an Attendant or
called station answer, the CLI provided by digital network will be stored in the CO message wait queue
145
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Operation
CLI message wait feature summary
[CALLBK] ⎯┬⎯ None - Retrieve CLI message.
⎯├⎯ [VOL UP/DOWN] - See next CLI message.
⎯├⎯ [HOLD] - Make a recall according to CLI message.
⎯├⎯ [CALLBK] - Toggle CLI message and SPEED Name.
⎯├⎯ [SPEED] + Bin# + [CONF] - Store CLI message in SPEED dial bin.
⎯├⎯ [CONF] - Delete current CLI message.
⎯├⎯ [DND] - Delete all CLI message.
⎯└⎯ At ATD: [TRANS/PGM]+055 - Delete all CLI message at ATD station.
To delete the current CLI Message and see the next one
1. Press [CONF] button.
2. Then the station user can see the next CLI message and current CLI message will be deleted.
146
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
1. CLI display works about any type of co service, if co line is ISDN. But CLI message wait only
works about DID/MSN co service type of ISDN line.
2. The total number of CLI message wait is 500. (on System base)
3. Station without LCD can not receive CLI message wait even though CLIP is set to ON.
4. CLI messages are saved against power failure.
5. When the call is routed to Ring Group, CLI Message is waited only the first member of Ring Group.
6. When the call is routed to a member of UCD/ Circular/ Terminal station group, the CLI Message
Wait will be provided to the first ringing station.
7. If the external party release the line during the VMIB announcement, the CLI Message Wait is not
saved to any stations. But the external party release the line during that a station is ringing after
the VMIB announcement, the CLI Message Wait will be remained at the first ringing station.
8. Though the call is routed to the station(A) that is forwarded to the other station(B), the CLI
Message Wait is provided to the original station(A). The basic rule for CLI Message Wait follows
the rule of “Message Wait” feature.
9. If there is no buffer, following warning message will be printed out through RS-232C.
“WARNING: CLI MESSAGE WAITING BUFFER FULL”
10. If the CLI number is programmed in the SPEED BIN No. Table with the “name” and the CLI name
display ADMIN programmed, then the name will be displayed in the LCD. The CLI number and CLI
user name is toggled by pressing [CALLBK] button.
11. When a user try to delete the all CLI message at his station and some VMIB voice message wait
exist together with CLI message, the “all CLI delete” feature can not be activated. Because the
priority of the message wait is as following:
VMIB message wait -> CLI message wait -> VM Group message wait
12. If the duplicated CLI messages are left at a station, LCD of the station will display the CLI
message with the CLI duplicated counter (max 15) and the latest message left time.
13. If CLI print admin program set, CLI and Station Number are printed through RS-232C port.
2.14.3 CLIR/COLR
Description
CLIR(Calling Line Identification Restriction) & COLR(Connected Line Identification Restriction) are
used, that calling party & called party inform to the public switching system, that they don’t want to
send their phone number to the other party.
147
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
If CLIR or COLR is requested, the PSTN restricts the transmission of CLI. If CLIR is set to ON, calling
party number is not sent to the called party. If COLR is set to ON, the connected party number is not
sent to the calling party.
Admin Programming
ISDN CLIR 4.1.5.13 (PGM 114 – FLEX 14)
ISDN COLR 4.1.5.14 (PGM 114 – FLEX 15)
Description
COLP is the same service as CLI, except that the transmitted information is the telephone number of
the answered party.
Admin Programming
COLP LCD Display 4.1.5.2 (PGM 114 – FLEX 2)
ISDN COLR 4.1.5.14 (PGM 114 – FLEX 15)
COLP Table 4.8.2 (PGM 201)
COLP Table Index 4.2.4.1 (PGM 143 – FLEX 1)
Description
The LDK system supports the key pad dialing feature. The key pad facility dialing is the feature that
the dialed digit information is sent through the key pad facility IE(Information Element) instead of the
called party IE. The key pad facility dialing is executed when pressing the programmed flexible button
as {Keypad Facility}.
Operation
1. When pressing the programmed {Keypad Facility} flexible button after seizing a CO line (ISDN),
the system will send the dialed digits as Keypad Facility IE instead of Called Party Number IE in
INFORMATION message to the network.
2. When a ISDN terminal user sends "#" using Keypad Facility IE with subsequent digits after seizing
a CO line (ISDN), the system will send all dialed digits as Keypad Facility IE to network even if the
codes are matched with internal supplementary service code (Ex. "*#" to hold CO line).
3. Keypad Facility IE Sending will be stopped automatically, when user releases the CO line (ISDN),
or pressing the programmed {Keypad Facility} flexible button during dialing digits.
Condition
1. To assign {Keypad Facility} flexible button,
[TRANS/PGM] + Flex. BTN + [TRANS/PGM] + 8 9 + [HOLD/SAVE]
2. The Keypad Facility Access Authority (ADMIN program 114 – FLEX 6) should be set to ON to use
this feature.
148
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
3. This feature can be activated by pressing the {Keypad Facility} flexible button after seizing a
ISDN CO line.
4. When this feature is activated, the system starts to send Keypad Facility IE instead of Called Party
Number IE regardless of CONNECT message from the network unless pressing {Keypad
Facility} button to deactivate it. So the system will continue to send Keypad Facility IE instead of
DTMF tone even after CONNECT message is received from the network.
5. If the Speed Dial is stored with [FLASH] as the first digit for ISDN line and the station has the
Keypad Facility Access authority, the digits after [FLASH] command will be sent as Keypad Facility
and the feature will be deactivated after sending all digits.
6. When any of the following features are encountered after the Keypad Facility is activated, the
feature will be deactivated automatically;
- Pressing function keys as [REDIAL], [TRANS/PGM], [FLASH], [HOLD/SAVE], [CONF]
- Pressing CO keys as CO, CO Group, Loop
- Pressing Flex. Buttons assigned some features as {SPEED}, {DSS}, {Call Park}, {Keypad
Facility}
- Making On-hook
- When DISCONNECT message is received from the network
7. This feature may not be operated depending on the services that require to handle two call
references at the same time after B channel connection is made as Hold & Retrieving, Conference,
etc.
8. The Speed Dial Numbers started with [FLASH] (display “D”) send saved digits as Keypad Facility
IE instead of Called Party Number IE. After sending all Speed Dial Numbers, this feature is
deactivated automatically.
9. When the system receives a Called Party Number IE during sending Keypad Facility IE, the
system will stop sending the Keypad Facility IE.
10. “#” is not printed or saved in SMDR information when sending Keypad Facility IE.
Admin Programming
Keypad Facility Access 4.1.5.6 (PGM 114 – FLEX 6)
Description
LDK system is supporting ISDN-SS-MCID (ISDN Supplementary Service – Malicious Call ID). The
protocol standard about MCID is referred the EN300-130.
Operation
MCID Request BTN at Station FLEX BTN:
[Trans/PGM] + {Flex. Button} + ‘*0’ + [Hold]
149
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
1.It can be used within only ISDN network that supports ISDN-SS MCID service.
Admin Programming
MCID Request Code 3.2.9 (PGM 109 – FLEX 1)
2.14.7 MSN/Sub-Addressing
Description
When several ISDN devices are connected to a single ISDN port, the numbering method of each
station is as follows;
150
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Sub-Addressing
The sub-addressing allows the called user to expand his addressing capacity beyond the one given by
the ISDN number.
Matched? Yes
(CO & Tel No)
No
Yes
Matched?
No
Search PGM231 Table
Figure 2.14.3 The flow chart of MSN call process in LDK system.
Condition
1. To use an ISDN line as MSN, the CO Service type should be set to DID/MSN.
2. The MSN can be assigned up to 250 ISDN numbers with MSN table.
3. MSN is carried from PX in CPN IE (Called Party Number Information Element).
4. If the received CPN is not matched with MSN table, the call will be operated as DID.
5. If a MSN call is received with an ISDN CO line and there are MSN table entries filled with the CO
field value, then only the MSN table entries of MSN CO programmed will be searched. But, if there
is no MSN table entry filled with the CO field value, then all MSN table entries will be searched.
6. Max. 8 devices can be connected to a S0 part. It is required to have individual ISDN terminal
power feeding to use them.
7. The sub-address is carried from PX in CPSN (Called Party Sub-address Number) IE.
8. Only one digit (0~9) can be used for sub-addressing.
Admin Programming
CPN Type 4.1.5.8 (PGM 114 – FLEX 8)
151
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
This feature allows the user to make another call without using other channel. When the HOLD
supplementary service is invoked, communication on a B-channel is interrupted and the B-channel is
released. The network reserves the B-channel used by the user for subsequent reuse. With this
feature, ISDN-Broker Call and Call Waiting are available.
Operation
To hold the current call:
1. Press the [FLASH] key during conversation
2. Press the [HOLD] key. Or
Press programmed {SUPP HOLD} button.
Condition
1. Both keypad protocol and functional protocol are implemented.
2. [FLASH] and [HOLD] keys or pre-programmed {SUPP HOLD} are needed for this feature.
{SUPP HOLD} key can be made by Code [TRANS/PGM] *75#.
3. ISDN Call Hold feature is available during conversation.
4. The line, which is associated with this ISDN supplementary service, can not be transferred to
other stations or can not be retrieved from other stations. And the held channel can be retrieved
only by the station which held the channel before.
5. When a call is on hold, the associated LED for the line will flash at 480 IPM in the station that uses
the line. And all the LED’s will be ON (busy) in the other stations.
6. When a call is on hold and the user make a new call, the associated LED for the line at the station
will be ON.
Admin Programming)
152
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
This feature allows a station user engaged in one ISDN CO line to hold that call and can originate
another call by using the same channel. Once the second call is established, the originating station
may alternate between calls carrying on a private conversation with either party.
Operation
To hold the current call;
1. Press the [FLASH] key during conversation.
2. Press the [HOLD] key. Or
Press programmed {SUPP HOLD} button.
Condition
1. Both keypad protocol and functional protocol are implemented.
2. [FLASH] and [HOLD] keys or pre-programmed {SUPP HOLD} are needed for this feature. {SUPP
HOLD} key can be made by Code [TRANS/PGM] *75#.
3. ISDN Call Hold feature is available during conversation.
4. ISDN-Broker Call is available during conversation.
5. The ISDN CO line, which is associated with this ISDN-Broker call, can not be transferred to the
other station. And the held channel can be retrieved only by the station which held the channel.
6. SDN-Broker Call is associated with Call Waiting
Admin Programming
ISDN Attribute II (PGM203)
Description
ISDN Supplementary Service ETSI Conference(ISDN-SS-EC). The feature allows user to make a 3 party
conference with one ISDN B channel.
153
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Operation
To make a 3 party conversation
Press [FLASH] + [CONF] whilst ISDN broker call is in progress with one hold and another call on
conversation.
Condition
1. Only ETSI protocol is implemented.
2. [FLASH], [HOLD] and [CONF] or {SUPP HOLD}, {SUPP CONF} keys are needed for this feature.
Related Features
1.ISDN-CALL\HOLD/RETRIVE
2.ISDN-BROKER CALL
Related Standards
1. EN 300-196-1 ( Integrated Services Digital Network (ISDN); Generic functional protocol for the
support of supplementary services)
2. EN 300-188-1(3 PTY Supplementary service)
Admin Programming
ISDN Attribute II HOLD/RETRIEVE TYPE (PGM203)
154
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
This feature enables the adjustment of the COS(Class of Service) of ISDN CO lines in LDK-20. That is
to change the current COS of the CO line from C5(all outgoing calls are possible) to C2(outgoing calls
only for specific numbers) and vice versa.
.
Operation
To activate COS down at Attendant station
1. Press the {CO} key.
2. Press the programmed key for {Call barring}. Or
Press [FLASH] key + 2 + 0.
3. Service accepted and/or rejected by PX and display during off- hook state.
Or service rejected and/or rejected by PX and display during off- hook state.
4. Call barring key and {CO} Key and LED is flashing at 50 IPM when this feature key is activated
Condition
1. This feature is only available in national keypad protocol.
2. Password code for call barring is not possible to program to flexible button. So, user always should
dial this code.
3.This feature is supported only access basis. So, only ATD station can activate this feature. If normal
station tries to use this feature, then error tone is heard.
4. {Call Barring} key is used as toggled key(class up/down).
5. If this feature is activated, ISDN Co line COS changes according to service type(class up/down).
When the COS is changed to C2 state, the services available in all ISDN co lines depend on the PX.
2.14.11.2 ISDN – Call Forward Unconditional (CFU, Italy national protocol) – ATD
only
Description
This feature re-routes (forward) a specific CO Line call to outside specific another subscriber number.
PX will transfer a predefined specific subscriber’s CO line call to another subscriber number according
to CO line/subscriber number
.
Operation
155
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
1. This feature is only available in national keypad protocol.
2. This feature can only activated by using preprogrammed flexible button.
3. If the CFU feature is activated {CFU Activate with Destination} key LED will flash at 30 IPM.
4. This feature is supported only access basis. So, only ATD station can activate this feature. If normal
station tries to use this feature, then error tone is heard.
5. If this feature is activated incoming co calls are unconditionally transferred to the predefined
destination.
Description
Memo-Tel is a feature transferring the incoming co call to the MSG Storage system of the PX when co
line is busy or when there is no answer. This feature can be activated selectively activated in normal
case(busy or no answer) or only in no answer case. And also the user can check the messages left
in the PX.
.
Operation
To activate Memo-Tel
1. Press the {CO} key.(Attendant only.)
2.Press the programmed key for {MEMO-TEL Activation Normal}, or [FLASH] key + 2 + 5 for
Normal activation.
3. Service accepted by PX and display during off-hook state. Or service rejected by PX and display
during off-hook state.
4. When the station goes to on-hook state normal LCD will be displayed.
156
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
To deactivate Memo-Tel
1. Press the {CO} key.(Attendant only.)
2. Press the programmed key for {MEMO-TEL Deactivation}, or [FLASH] key + 2 + 4 for Normal
deactivation.
3. Service accepted by PX and display during off-hook state. Or service rejected by PX and display
during off-hook state.
Retrieve of MSRS
1. Press the {CO} key.(Attendant only.)
2. Press the programmed key for {MEMO-TEL Retrieve MSRS Code}, Or [FLASH] key + 2 + 9. Then
you will hear announcement to enter password or if rejected announcement about wrong access.
3. Dial Password and # for identifying your password.( Password in 4 digits.)
4. Dial desired code according to PX announcement.
Condition
1. Memo-Tel is only available in national keypad protocol.
2. If this feature is activated by attendant station (access basis), then the ISDN lines are in MEMO-TEL
mode. To retrieve stored message or enquiry of service status at attendant station, attendant should
to retrieve of MSRS or enquiry of status for all CO lines respectively.
3. If this feature is activated by normal station (number basis), then the first CO line for this station in
MSN table is in MEMO-TEL mode. So, the user should be assigned with the specific subscriber
number and co number to MSN table. If no co number is assigned to MSN table, system will
choose the first co as default. To retrieve stored message or enquiry of service status at normal
station, normal station need not to access CO line.
4.To know service status, user should be inquire of service status to PX using ‘Enquiry of service
status service’.
5. Station when having numbers for not only one co line the first one appearing in the MSN table will
be chosen.
Description
This feature is established by receiving IP numbers or dialing IP numbers directly.
157
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Operation
Press the desired {CO} line, {POOL}, or {LOOP} button or dial the CO line or group code
When hearing Dial Tone, dial the IP address of Called Party sequentially. In stead of “.”, “*” must be
dialed.
(e.g. IP Address: 156.147.3.201, Dialed number:156*147*3*201)
Press “#” button to call.
If Called Party is IP LDK system, Ring will follow the Ring Assignment(ADMIN program 144)
Condition
When programming Speed Dial for Direct Call, “#” must not be inserted.
(e.g. To assign 156*147*3*139 to Speed Dial, Just enter “156*147*3*139” not “156*147*3*139#”)
In DISA Incoming, Co Access is denied if the line seized by dialing Co Access Code is VOIB line
Admin Programming
CO Line Service Type 4.2.1 (PGM 140)
VOIB IP Setting 4.13.1 (PGM 340)
Description
This feature is established by dialing Station number programmed in NETWORK ROUTING
TABLE(PGM324)
Operation
Dial the station number included in the range from start range to end range in network routing table.
System will select one VOIP Co line in the CO Group assigned in network routing table.
User will be heard Ring Back Tone if this call is possible.
In case of error or busy or no answer, Call will follow DID/DISA destination(ADMIN program 167).
Condition
For the call via Network Table, VOIB call follows the ISDN DID Call Procedure.(DID conversion Type,
Digit conversion Table, Flexible DID Table etc)
VOIP CO call does not follow Ring Assignment even if DID/DISA destinations are set to attendant.
The call just will be transferred to Attendant directly.
If network routing table have more than one table entries that is the same routing number but the
destination is different, the call is routed to the destination of the front entry of network routing
table.
To transfer the incoming call to other system via VOIB, transferring user must not drop the call before
hearing Ring Back Tone.
Just DSS, HUNT, VMIB, VMIB # and System Speed can be the destination for the Flexible DID
Table(ADMIN program 231).
158
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Admin Programming
CO Line Service Type 4.2.1 (PGM 140) –ISDN DID/MSN
VOIB IP Setting 4.13.1 (PGM 340)
DID Conversion Type 4.2.4.4 (PGM143 – FLEX 4)
Flexible DID Table 4.11.4 (PGM231) – (used in case of DID Conversion Type 2)
Networking CO Group 4.12.3.1 (PGM322 – FLEX 1)
Networking Routing Table 4.12.4 (PGM324)
Network Configurations
The system can support various network configurations via Internet and up to 72 systems (including
itself) can be combined on the network.
MPB VoIP
159
LAN
LAN LAN
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Networking Protocols
The system can support H.450 over IP – for the basic networking functions and the proprietary
protocol for the advanced networking functions.
Requirement
To use the networking features, the software lock-key installation is required. Each IP LDK system
has own unique software lock-key. To get the software lock-key, contact the distributor of IP LDK
system.
Numbering Plan
Unified Dialing Plan (UDP) : In the IP LDK networking system, the UDP numbering plan is used. In
the UDP networking, the stations of each system can have a unique station number from 2 digits up
to 7 digits. The unique station number is assigned according to the numbering plan of each IP LDK
system. The figure 2.16.3 describes the networking configuration that is configured by UDP
numbering plan. In this figure, the symbol of ‘x’ represents the ranged digit as ‘0 ~ 9’.
Station Station
4xxx 2xxx
IP
Station Station
5xxx 3xxx
160
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
In the networking configuration, a station user can make a call to a station in other networking systems
by dialing only a station number just as an intercom call within the same system. This service is
defined as ‘NET CALL’. The figure 2.16.4 describes the net call operation in VOIP networking
connection.
161
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Call Flow
Step Flow
1 Station 101 dials 202 that is a station number of other system.
2 System searches Networking Numbering Table.
3 2** matches 202, (2** means ‘200 ~ 299’)
System gets the destination IP address that is assigned for station 202.
4
(For example 10.152.32.67 or 192.168.1.1)
5 VoIP net call goes to destination IP
6 Ringing at the exact destination (202)
7 Destination (202) answers
8 Conversation
Note : During conversation, all telephony features are available.
For example, call transfer, hold, conference and etc
Operation
To make a net call, lift handset or press the [MON] button. The system provides a user with a dial tone.
Dial the station number of other networking systems, or if station has the [NET DSS] button that
contains the net call station number, then the net call is made by pressing the [NET DSS] button.
The station seizes the network CO line according to the net routing table, and the system sends a digit
stream that is modified by the net routing table.
The called system receives a digit stream that is sent by calling system, and analyzes it using the net
routing table to determine the right destination station. The destination station receives a ringing
signal.
The LED of [COL] flexible button, that is represent the CO line for net call, will be extinguished when
the net call is cleared.
Condition
To make a net call, like to intercom call, station user must dial the destination station number without
seizing a CO line.
After station user makes a net call, the IP LDK system seizes a idle CO line to send the net call
request to the destination station. But if there is no selectable idle CO line, then user hears an
162
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
error tone .
The received net call is always ringing as the terminal answer mode, regardless the intercom answer
mode setting(Hands-free/Terminal/Privacy).
When system detects the fatal error from the network, system sends the digit stream to the network
using the alternate speed dial bin. In this case, the call is not a networking call.
The Net Call is also applied CO Call Restriction Timer (ADMIN program 180 – FLEX 17).
ADMIN Programming
Networking Basic Attribute 4.12.1 (PGM 320)
Networking CO Line Attribute 4.12.3 (PGM 322)
Network Routing Table(Numbering Plan) 4.12.4 (PGM 324)
Two IP LDK systems A and B are connected through VOIB. And the customer want to program the
networking between two IP LDK systems as follows.
First, to enable the networking feature, the ADMIN program 320 – FLEX 1 must be set to ON. at each
system. If the networking lock-key is not installed, this ADMIN program can not be enabled.
Second, to satisfy the UDP condition, the ADMIN program of ‘FLEXIBLE STATION NUMBERING
PLAN’ (PGM 105) must be programmed at each system. At this ADMIN program, the station number
range of system A can be changed from 100 to 199 (100 ~ 199), and system B’s also can be
changed from 200 to 299 (200 ~ 299). The changed station number must not be conflicted with
the flexible number plan code of each system. (For example, if system A has a flexible numbering
code ‘2’ as PICK-UP code, then station number, that is started by digit ‘2’, can not be used).
Third, the destination IP address is needed to route. So, in this case, the IP address of destination
system’s VOIB must be set at ADMIN program 324 – FLEX button 4.
The ADMIN program to configure the VOIP networking between system A & B are summarized like
below.
At system A : Enter ADMIN program 105 + [SPEED] + ‘100’ + ‘199’ + [HOLD]
At system B : Enter ADMIN program 105 + [SPEED] + ‘200’ + ‘299’ + [HOLD]
Fourth, to configure the networking CO line connection, the ADMIN program of ‘CO SERVICE TYPE’
(PGM 140), ‘DID CONVERSION TYPE’ (PGM 143 – FLEX 4), ‘DID RECEIVE DIGIT’ & ‘DID DIGIT
MASK’ (PGM 146 – FLEX 5 & 6), ‘FLEXIBLE DID TABLE’ (PGM 231), ‘NET CO GROUP’ & ‘NET CO
TYPE’ (PGM 322 – FLEX 1 & 4) must be programmed appropriately at each system. The networking
CO line is defined that it connects the networking systems and it is used for the networking signaling
message and voice path. To use the networking CO line, the service type must be set to DID/MSN at
ADMIN program 140. And to receive the net call digit information correctly, the appropriate DID
conversion type must be set at ADMIN program 143 – FLEX 4. In this example, DID TYPE 1 satisfies
the situation. To configure the net CO line connection, the net CO group and type must be set to ‘01’
and ‘NET’ at ADMIN program 322 – FLEX 1 & 4.
At system A & B
163
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
At system A
Description
Between the networking systems, the name of station can be transmitted via the networking signaling
messages. In the IP LDK system, the name of station can be programmed at the station program
menu ‘74’ ([Trans/PGM] + ‘74’). CNIP(Calling Name Identification Presentation) is defined that the
name of station is transmitted when an outgoing call is made. And CONP(connected Name
164
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
identification Presentation) is defined that the name of station is transmitted when an incoming call is
answered. If the opposite side networking system is received the name of station, then it is displayed
on LCD.
Operation
CNIP and CONP operation is executed whenever the station of networking system makes a call and it
answers the incoming call.
Condition
To used CNIP and CONP service, the name of station and the related ADMIN program 320 – FLEX 3
& 4 must be set properly.
Admin Programming
Networking CNIP Enable 4.12.1.3 (PGM 320 – FLEX 3)
Networking CONP Enable 4.12.1.4 (PGM 320 – FLEX 4)
Description
A station user of the networking system can use the net transfer service. The net transfer is the call
transfer service that is using the net call. It can transfer any kind of call to a station in other systems by
pressing [TRANS/PGM] button and dialing the station number. The executive operation of net transfer
is the same as the call transfer service within the same system. And it also supports the two kinds of
transfer modes; screened transfer mode and unscreened transfer mode (see Ref.1).
Engineering notice) There are defined two kinds of standard net transfer signaling method in QSIG
and H.450 protocol specification; TRANSFER BY JOIN and TRANSFER BY REROUTING. The main
difference is how the connecting path among the transferring, transferred, transferred-to stations
controls.
The term of transferred station is the call originator. In the figure 2.16.5, the outside caller is the
transferred station.
The term of transferred-to station is the new destination of the transferred call. In the figure 2.16.5, the
station 202 is the transferred-to station.
And the term of transferring station is a station transferring a call with transferred station, to
transferred-to station. In the figure 2.16.5, the station 100 is the transferring station.
165
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
In case of TRANSFER BY JOIN, additional connecting path will be needed to transfer the call to
another station. In case of TRANSFER BY REROUTING, new connecting path is used to transfer the
call and old connecting path of transferring station will be cleared.
IP LDK system supports both TRANSFER BY JOIN and TRANSFER BY REROUTING. The signaling
method can be selected by ADMIN program 321 – FLEX 1.
The figure 2.16.5 describes the unscreened net transfer operation on the networking connection
environment. At the first step, the outside caller dials the telephone number of station 100. And station
100 is receiving the incoming ring at the second step. At the third step, station 100 answers and it is
requested the call transfer to the station 202 that is located the another networking system. To
execute the net transfer, the station 100 presses [TRANS/PGM] button and dials ‘202’. After hearing
ring back tone, station 100 goes idle. Station 202 receives the net transfer ring and answers at the fifth
step.
Call Flow
Step Flow
1 Outside Caller dials a station in the networking system
2 Call comes in, the station 100 receive a ring.
3 Station 100 answers and converse
Step 1 ~ 2 4 Station 100 transfers the call to 202,and goes idle
5 Station 202 rings and answers
6 Conversation
PSTN or ISDN
Step 3 Step 6
166
Internet
Step 4
100
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Operation
Screened transfer
Press the [TRANS/PGM] button at a transferring station during conversation. The transferred call is
placed on EXCLUSIVE HOLD(see Ref.2).
At the transferring station, dial the station number of another networking system to transfer the call.
The transferred-to station of another system receives a ring signal.
When the transferred-to station answers, the voice path is connected between the transferring and
the transferred-to stations.
Both stations can make a conversation each other, but the held transferred caller is still in
waiting for an answer.
The transferred caller and the transferred-to station can make a conversation when the transferring
station hangs up.
Unscreened transfer
Press the [TRANS/PGM] button at a station during conversation. The transferred call is placed on
EXCLUSIVE HOLD(see Ref.2).
At the transferring station, dial the station number of another networking system to transfer the call,
and go on-hook. The transferring station goes idle, and the transferred-to station of another
system receives a ring signal.
The transferred caller and the transferred-to station can make a conversation when the transferred-
to station answers the ringing.
Condition
If both transferred stations and transferred-to stations are located in the same system, the networking
CO line that is used for transferring voice path is not needed. That is, the transfer call will be setup
as intercom call.
The net transfer will be canceled when transferring station user presses the flashing [TRANS/PGM]
button.
After the transferring station goes on-hook, the net transfer call doesn’t recall to the transferring
station though the transferred-to station doesn’t answer for long time.
If there is no idle networking CO line path for net transfer, the error tone will be heard.
If the call is transferred to a busy station, the busy tone will be heard.
167
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Reference
Screened and unscreened transfer mode : Section 2.3.2
Exclusive hold : Section 2.3.3
Admin Programming
Networking Basic Attribute 4.12.1 (PGM 320)
Networking Transfer Mode 4.12.2.1 (PGM 321 – FLEX 1)
Networking CO Line Attribute 4.12.3 (PGM 322)
Network Routing Table(Numbering Plan) 4.12.4 (PGM 324)
Description
It is possible for a user to forward his station remotely and immediately over the network when it
receives a ring signal.
Engineering notice).
There are two kinds of standard net call forward signaling method in H.450 protocol specification
defined; JOIN and REROUTING. The main difference is how the connecting path among the
forwarding, forwarded, forwarded-to stations controls.
The term of forwarded station is the call originator. The forwarded station is rerouted to the forwarded-
to station by forwarding station. In the figure 2.16.6, the outside caller is the forwarded station.
The term of forwarded-to station is the new destination of the forwarded call. In the figure 2.16.6, the
station 202 is the forwarded-to station.
And the term of forwarding station is a station forwarding a call, to forwarded-to station. In the figure
2.16.6, the station 100 is the forwarding station.
IP LDK system supports both JOIN and REROUTING. The signaling method can be selected by
ADMIN program 321 – FLEX 1.
The figure 2.16.6 describes the unconditional net call forward operation on the networking connection
environment. At the first step, the station 100 is set the unconditional net call forward to the forwarded-
to destination 202. At the second step, the outside caller is dialed the telephone number of station
100. At the third step, the networking system of station 100 is forwarding the incoming call to station
202, that is located the another networking system. At the fourth step, station 202 is receiving a ring
signal from the outside caller. After answering, station 202 can make a conversion with the call
forwarded caller at the fifth step.
Call
Step Flow
Flow
1 Station 100 set forward to 202
2 Outside Caller dials in Station 100
3 Call is forwarding to Station 202
Step 2
4 Station 202 rings instead of 100.
5 Conversation
Figure 2.16.6 The unconditional net call forward operation on the networking connection environment
Operation
To activate Net Call Forward
Press the [MON] button and the [DND/FOR] button
Dial Net Call Forward code “1”, and dial the station number of another networking system.
The [DND/FOR] button will be flashing and a confirmation tone will be provided.
If there is incoming call to the net call unconditional forwarding station, the call is routed to a
forwarded-to station immediately, and the forwarded-to station is ringing.
When the forwarded-to station is answered, the call forwarded and forwarded-to station can make a
conversation.
Condition
If both call forwarded stations and call forwarded-to stations are located in the same system, the
networking path CO line that is used for forward voice path is not needed. That is, the forwarded
call will be setup as intercom call.
At the forwarding system, it does not check the status of the forwarded-to station, that is in DND, CFW
or Empty, when it set the net call forward.
Admin Programming
Call Forward Attribute 4.1.2.2 (PGM 111 – FLEX 2)
Networking Basic Attribute 4.12.1 (PGM 320)
Networking Transfer Mode 4.12.2.1 (PGM 321 – FLEX 1)
169
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
It is possible for a user to forward his station remotely over the network when it is busy.
Engineering notice).
There are two kinds of standard net call forward signaling method in H.450 protocol specification
defined; JOIN and REROUTING. The main difference is how the connecting path among the
forwarding, forwarded, forwarded-to stations controls.
The term of forwarded station is the call originator. The forwarded station is rerouted to the forwarded-
to station by forwarding station.
The term of forwarded-to station is the new destination of the forwarded call.
And the term of forwarding station is a station forwarding a call, to forwarded-to station.
IP LDK system supports both JOIN and REROUTING. The signaling method can be selected by
ADMIN program 321 – FLEX 1.
Operation
To activate Net Call Forward
Press the [MON] button and the [DND/FOR] button
Dial Net Call Forward code “2”, and dial the station number of another networking system.
The [DND/FOR] button will be flashing and a confirmation tone will be provided.
If there is incoming call to the net call busy forwarding station, the call is routed to a forwarded-to
station when the called station is busy, and the forwarded-to station is ringing.
When the forwarded-to station is answered, the call forwarded and forwarded-to station can make a
conversation.
Condition
If both of call forwarded and forwarded-to stations are located in the same system, the networking
path CO line is not needed that is used for forward voice path. That is, the forwarded call will be
setup as intercom call.
At the forwarding system, it does not check the status of the forwarded-to station, that is in DND,
CFW or Empty, when it set the net call forward.
Admin Programming
Call Forward Attribute 4.1.2.2 (PGM 111 – FLEX 2)
Networking Basic Attribute 4.12.1 (PGM 320)
Networking Transfer Mode 4.12.2.1 (PGM 321 – FLEX 1)
Networking CO Line Attribute 4.12.3 (PGM 322)
170
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
It is possible for a user to forward his station remotely over the network when it does not answer within
the CFW NO ANS(Call Forward No Answer) Timer or busy.
Engineering notice).
There are two kinds of standard net call forward signaling method in H.450 protocol specification
defined; JOIN and REROUTING. The main difference is how the connecting path among the
forwarding, forwarded, forwarded-to stations controls.
The term of forwarded station is the call originator. The forwarded station is rerouted to the forwarded-
to station by forwarding station.
The term of forwarded-to station is the new destination of the forwarded call.
And the term of forwarding station is a station forwarding a call, to forwarded-to station.
IP LDK system supports both JOIN and REROUTING. The signaling method can be selected by
ADMIN program 321 – FLEX 1.
Operation
To activate Net Call Forward
Press the [MON] button and the [DND/FOR] button
Dial Net Call Forward code “4”, and dial the station number of another networking system. The
[DND/FOR] button will be flashing and a confirmation tone will be provided.
If there is an incoming call to the net call busy/no answer forwarding station, the call is routed to a
forwarded-to station, when the called station is busy or does not answer within a CFW NO ANS
timer, and the forwarded-to station is ringing.
When the forwarded-to station is answered, the call forwarded and forwarded-to station can make a
conversation.
Admin Programming
Call Forward Attribute 4.1.2.2 (PGM 111 – FLEX 2)
Networking Basic Attribute 4.12.1 (PGM 320)
Networking Transfer Mode 4.12.2.1 (PGM 321 – FLEX 1)
Networking CO Line Attribute 4.12.3 (PGM 322)
171
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
It is possible for a user to forward his station remotely over the network when it does not answer within
the CFW NO ANS(Call Forward No Answer) Timer.
Engineering notice).
There are two kinds of standard net call forward signaling method in H.450 protocol specification
defined; JOIN and REROUTING. The main difference is how the connecting path among the
forwarding, forwarded, forwarded-to stations controls.
The term of forwarded station is the call originator. The forwarded station is rerouted to the forwarded-
to station by forwarding station.
The term of forwarded-to station is the new destination of the forwarded call.
And the term of forwarding station is a station forwarding a call, to forwarded-to station.
IP LDK system supports both JOIN and REROUTING. The signaling method can be selected by
ADMIN program 321 – FLEX 1.
Operation
To activate Net Call Forward
Press the [MON] button and the [DND/FOR] button
Dial Net Call Forward code “3”, and dial the station number of another networking system. The
[DND/FOR] button will be flashing and a confirmation tone will be provided.
If there is an incoming call to the net call no answer forwarding station, the call is routed to a
forwarded-to station, when the called station does not answer within a CFW NO ANS timer, and
the forwarded-to station is ringing.
When the forwarded-to station is answered, the call forwarded and forwarded-to station can make a
conversation.
Admin Programming
Call Forward Attribute 4.1.2.2 (PGM 111 – FLEX 2)
Networking Basic Attribute 4.12.1 (PGM 320)
Networking Transfer Mode 4.12.2.1 (PGM 321 – FLEX 1)
Networking CO Line Attribute 4.12.3 (PGM 322)
Network Routing Table(Numbering Plan) 4.12.4 (PGM 324)
172
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
The net conference is the same service as the conference that is described at Section 2.7(see Ref.1),
except that the networking station can be assigned the conference member.
Operation
To make a Net Conference
At the conference master station, press the [CONF] button, during conversation through the
network call. The connected call is on hold and an intercom dial tone is provided.
Make a Net Call to a station of other networking system.
At the conference master station, press the [CONF] button when second called station is answered.
The second call is on hold and an ICM dial tone is provided.
At the conference master station, press the [CONF] button again. Then the conference voice path
to all members are connected, and all members can make a conversation.
Condition
IP phone can not be a master station of the Net Conference.
Engineering notice)
When IP phone sends Invite Setup to Non-IP phone, this message will be rejected.
When Non IP phone is going to invite IP phone, normal Setup message should send to the IP
phone instead of Invite Setup message.
Reference
Conference : Section 2.7
Admin Programming
Networking Basic Attribute 4.12.1 (PGM 320)
Network Routing Table(Numbering Plan) 4.12.4 (PGM 324)
Description
The CALL OFFER is the same service as the CAMP-ON that is described at Section 2.4.5(see Ref.1),
except that the camp on is executed on the networking connection environment. The term of CALL
OFFER is used at H.450 protocol standard specification.
When a station user make a net call to a busy station that is located on other networking system, busy
tone is heard. At that time, the caller can give a signal to the busy station by using of CALL OFFER
service. The busy station (through the receiver or on speakerphone) is notified of the call waiting by a
camp-on tone and flashing LED of the [HOLD/SAVE] button.
173
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
The figure 2.16.7 describes the call offer operation on the networking connection environment. At the
first step, the station 100 makes a net call to the busy station 202, but it hears the busy tone. To
execute the call offer service, the station 100 dials the camp-on code ‘¼’, at the second step. The call
offer request is sent to station 202, and it receives a camp-on signal tone, at the third and fourth steps.
Two stations can make a conversation, when the station 202 is pressing the [HOLD/SAVE] button.
Step 1
Internet
Step 2 Step 3
100
Step 5
BUSY
Step 4 202
Call Flow
Step Flow
1 Station 100 dials 202, but hears BUSY tone
2 100 dials camp-on code “*”
3 Call is routed to Station 202
4 Station 202 gets camp-on signaling
5 Conversation by pressing Hold button
Figure 2.16.7 The call offer operation on the networking connection environment
Operation
To activate Call Offer
1. Dial a busy station number of another networking system. The caller hears a busy tone.
2. Press the camp-on code ‘¼’ during hearing a busy tone. The busy station receives an off-hook
muted ring. The calling station hears a ring-back tone instead of a busy-tone.
Condition
174
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Reference
Camp On : Section 2.4.5
Admin Programming
Networking Basic Attribute 4.12.1 (PGM 320)
Description
The call completion is the same service as the call back that is described at Section 2.4.16(see Ref.1),
except that this service is executed on the networking connection environment. The term of call
completion is used at H.450 protocol standard specification.
The call completion is separated into two types, CCBS(Completion of Calls to Busy Subscribers) and
CCNR(Completion of Calls on No Reply).
Step 1
Step 2
Internet
Step 3
100
Step 4
175
Step 5 BUSY
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Call Flow
Step Flow
1 Station 100 dials 202, but hears BUSY tone
2 Station 100 press [CALL BK] button, and goes to IDLE
3 Call-back ring to station 100 when 202 is IDLE
4 Station 100 lifts handset, then station 202 is ringing
5 Conversation
Operation
To make CCBS (Call Back)
Dial the station of another networking system that is busy.
Press the [CALLBK] button while a busy tone is provided. The call is cleared after a confirmation
tone.
The busy station goes to Idle, the originator receives a call-back ring.
When the originator answers to the call-back ring, a new call will be activated to the calling station.
Condition
CCBS is not supported for ISDN terminal. But some ISDN terminal that is guarantied by LG may
activate CCBS.
Stand-alone IP Phone that supports H.450 can activate the Call Completion feature.
A station can leave or have only one callback message, and a new request will cancel the previous
callback message.
A voice message cannot be left even though the VMIB is installed in a local system.
When the originator does not answer the call back ring within net timer, the call will be cleared.
There are two modes : One is connection mode and the other is disconnection mode. This can be
selectable at ADMIN program 320 – FLEX button 8.
References
Call Back : Section 2.4.16
Admin Programming
Networking Basic Attribute 4.12.1 (PGM 320 – FLEX 8)
176
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
A call to a station in DND mode can be denied though it is arrived from a station of other systems. The
calling party will hear a busy tone.
Operation
Go to DND mode at a station.
From a station of other system, dial the station number in DND mode. The caller hears a busy tone
with LCD display through the network. The DND station does not receive any ring signal.
Condition
When a station is in DND mode, the [NET DSS] of DND station is flashing if BLF(Busy Lamp Field)
manager(see Ref.1) is activated.
Reference
BLF Manager : Section 2.16.19
Admin Programming
DND Attribute 4.1.2.3 (PGM 111 – FLEX 3)
2.16.12 CO Transit - In
Description
The CO TRANSIT-IN is the net call routing service about the incoming DID/MSN call. The incoming
DID call can reroute to the net call destination in another networking system.
The figure 2.16.9 describes the CO TRANSIT-IN operation on the networking connection environment.
At the first step, the outside caller makes a DID call to the station 202, so the DID call request is
arrived at the master system. The networking system of station 202 is not connected to PSTN directly,
but it can be connected to PSTN through the another networking system(master system) as illustrated
figure 2.16.8. At the second step, the master system checks the received DID call destination. If the
DID destination is matched with a station of system, the DID call is routed to the station. But, if the DID
destination is not matched, the master system is search the network numbering plan table(see Ref.1),
whether the destination is matched with a station of the registered another networking system. In this
case, the master system transfers the received DID call request to the found networking system, like
to the third step. At the fourth step, the CO transit-in DID call is ringing to the station 202. The caller
can make a conversation when the station 202 is answered.
Call Flow
Step 1
177
PSTN or ISDN
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Step Flow
1 Outside Caller dials a station in slave system
Call comes in master system and search networking
2
numbering plan table.
Master transfers the call request to the found networking
3
system.
4 Call is ringing to station 202
5 Conversation
178
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Operation
A DID call is arrived from PABX.
There is no limit for selecting DID conversion type. According to the result of DID conversion, the
call will be routed.
Network CO line is seized automatically, and the call is transferred to the network destination.
The destination receives the ringing with CLI from PABX.
The outside user still hears a ring-back tone.
Both the outside user and the destination station can make a conversation when the destination
station answers the ringing.
Condition
Any timer is not assigned to the transit CO line.
Outside caller hears busy tone when a networking path is not available during transit.
Reference
Network Numbering Plan Table : Section 4.12.4
Admin Programming
Network Routing Table(Numbering Plan) 4.12.4 (PGM 324)
Description
The CO TRANSIT-OUT is the CO line lend service that is executed by the request of the slave
networking system that want to connect PSTN. This service can increase the using efficiency of CO
line and reduce call costs by routing outgoing CO calls to the nearest appropriate point on the network.
The system should provide sufficient digit translation and string analysis options to enable the switch
to route the call correctly.
The figure 2.16.10 describes the CO TRANSIT-OUT operation on the networking connection
environment. At the first step, the station 202 of the slave system dials the CO TRANSIT-OUT code,
that is registered the network numbering plan table(ADMIN program 324). The term of CO TARNSIT-
OUT code is that a station of slave system can seize the PSTN CO line of the master system. At the
second step, the slave system seizes a CO line that is preprogrammed for transmitting the CO
TRANSIT-OUT code to the master system. And, the dialed code is transmitted to the master system.
At the third step, the master system seizes a CO line that is preprogrammed to serve the lend request
by the CO TRANSIT-OUT code. After seizing the PSTN CO line, the master system sends the digit
information to PSTN that is dialed from the station of the slave system. At the fourth step, the called
user of PSTN receives the ring. The caller and called users can make a conversation when the called
user is answered.
179
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Call Flow
Step Flow
1 Station 202 dials CO transit code of PGM 324
2 Dialed digit goes to master system
Step 4 3 Master sizes the real PX CO line and dials
4 Outside party rings
5 Conversation
PSTN or ISDN
Step 3
Step 5
Internet
Step 2
Step 1
202
Additional Programming
Master :
PGM 322 BTN 1 (Net Col Group) = 02 for PSTN Lines
BTN 4 (Net CO Type) = PSTN
PGM 324 BIN 10
FLEX 1 (Usage) = PSTN
FLEX 2 (Net Code) = 9 (transit code) Delete 1st CO Group access code
FLEX 3 (Net CO Group) = 02
Slave :
PGM 324 BIN 10
FLEX 1 (Usage) = PSTN
FLEX 2 (Net Code) = 9 (transit code) Delete 1st CO Group access code
FLEX 3 (Net CO Group) = 01
FLEX 4 (CPN) = 192.168.23.21
FLEX 7 (DGT Repeat) = YES
180
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Operation
A station of slave system dials the CO TRANSIT-OUT code.
The slave system seizes a CO line that is preprogrammed for transmitting the CO TRANSIT-OUT
code to the master system
The master system seizes a CO line that is preprogrammed to serve the lend request by the CO
TRANSIT-OUT code.
After seizing the PSTN CO line, the master system sends the digit information to PSTN that is dialed
from the station of the slave system.
The called user of PSTN receives the ring. The caller and called users can make a conversation,
when the called user is answered.
Condition
To use CO transit-out service, the slave system user must dial CO transit-out code. If it press CO line
button, the CO transit-out service doesn’t executed.
The station COS of slave system is applied for toll restriction.
At the master system, the attendant must have the CO access authority about the public connection.
For CO transit out, any code will be available using NET routing table (PGM 324). But, if there is a
conflict between NET routing table and system numbering plan, system numbering plan has high
priority.
If the CO transit-out code is programmed at an entry of the network numbering plan table, then the
type value of this entry must be set to PSTN (ADMIN program 324 – FLEX 1).
If the slave system isn’t connected to the master system directly, the CO transit-out code can be
transmitted through other networking systems transparently by setting the ADMIN program 324 –
FLEX 7 at each networking systems.
At the master system, the PSTN CO lines are must be set the ADMIN program 322 – FLEX 4.
Admin Programming
Networking CO Line Type 4.12.3.2 (PGM 322 – FLEX 2)
Network Routing Table(Numbering Plan) 4.12.4 (PGM 324)
Description
The MWI(Message Waiting Indication) is the exactly same service as the CLI(Calling Line
Identification) message wait that is described at Section 2.14.2(see Ref.1).
A station can leave the CLI message of itself, when the station of other networking system doesn’t
answer. In this case, at the system of unanswered station located, the ADMIN program of CLI
message wait(PGM114 – FLEX 4) must be enabled. MWI is indicated by CLI message on station LCD.
Operation
To retrieve MWI message
1. Press the flashing [CALLBK] button.
2. MWI contents (CLI number, date and time, the calling count from the same CLI) will be shown on
LCD.
3. Press the volume up/down [] button. The previous MWI or the next MWI is displayed.
181
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
To delete the current CLI Message and see the next one
1. Press [CONF] button.
2. Current MWI message is cleared with a confirmation tone and the next MWI message is displayed.
Condition
MWI is applied to LCD panel installed station only.
When system makes a call back according to MWI data, the CO line is selected within the network
CO group.
Reference
CLI Message Wait : Section 2.14.2
Admin Programming
CLI Message Wait 4.1.5.4 (PGM114 – FLEX 4)
Networking Basic Attribute 4.12.1 (PGM 320)
Networking CO Line Attribute 4.12.3 (PGM 322)
Network Routing Table(Numbering Plan) 4.12.4 (PGM 324)
Description
The absent text message is the same service, that is described at Section 2.4.1(see Ref.1), except
that this service is executed on the networking connection environment.
If a station user absents his desk with the absent text message on his station LCD, if a station of
another networking system make a net call to this station, then the absent text message of this station
is transmitted to the caller station, and it is displayed on LCD.
Operation
Make a Net Call to a station which is selected the pre-selected message or custom message.
Condition
A text message is displayed on the LCD of calling station, but the called station over network still
receives ring signal.
This feature does not be supported when calling party is WHTU and Large LCD DKTU.
182
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Reference
Absent Text Message : Section 2.4.1
Description
The attendant call from a station of any networking system can be routed to the CA(Centralized
Attendant) of CAS master system.
This call will be queued when all centralized attendants are busy, like to the normal attendant call and
queuing operation(see Ref.1)
The figure 2.16.11 describes the CAS operation on the networking connection environment. In the
figure, there are four IP LDK networking systems. Among them, the IP LDK-A system is set to the CAS
master, so its’ attendant station is set to the centralized attendant station. From the other networking
systems, if a station dials the attendant call code, then the call request is routed to the centralized
attendant station of IP LDK-A.
IP LDK-A
(master)
CAS
Dial ATD Call
Dial ATD Call
IP LDK-D
(slave)
IP LDK-B
(slave) IP LDK-C
Dial ATD Call (slave)
CO
LINE
Operation
Dial attendant code at any station in the system, then the call will be routed to the Net attendant.
The system provides ring-back tone to the calling station, and the [Net DSS] button lights.
A centralized attendant receives ringing signal with LCD display.
The [Network CO] button of calling station light in centralized attendant.
183
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
ICM Call is routed to Net attendant if system attendant press ATD DND button and the next attendant
is Net attendant.
CO Call can be routed to Net attendant only if DID/DISA destination is ATD and the ring is not
assigned to any station.
The centralized attendant service should be enabled at satellite systems.
Local attendant of each system can activate other attendant features except the attendant call.
In the Master system, CO ring assign for Net CO lines should be deleted to support CAS.
Reference
CLI Message Wait : Section 2.13.2
Admin Programming
Networking CAS Enable 4.12.1.6 (PGM 320 - FLEX 6)
Attendant DND Button 4.1.6 (PGM 115) - STA PGM Button(Type 6) : 55
Net Attendant Assign 4.4.5 (PGM 164) - Net DSS cannot be assigned to the System Attendant.
DID/DISA Destination 4.4.8 (PGM 167)
CO Ring Assignment 4.2.5 (PGM 144)
Description
This function can support that all voice mail occurred in all systems can be recorded in an external
VMS.
Condition
The centralize VMS should be assigned in slave system, and the number of the centralized VMS
should use the representative number of mail access created in master system.
The numbering plan including the representative of mail access assigned in master system should be
included in the numbering plan of QSIG group in slave system.
Admin Programming
Network Destination MPB IP 4.12.4.6 (PGM 324 – FLEX 6)
Station Group Assign(Centralized VMS Assign) 4.7.1 (PGM 190)
184
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
A station of networking system is able to program a busy lamp appearance of the station status of
other networking system. The Busy Lamp Field (BLF) button can also be used to make a net call the
networking station.
To use BLF service, the BLF manager software, PC application, must be installed at PC. The term of
the GATE KEEPER is the PC server, that is installed the BLF manager software and executing it.
The figure 2.16.12 describes the BLF operation on the networking configuration with the gate keeper.
In the figure, there are four IP LDK networking systems. Among them, the station 4100, 5111, 6210
have the BFL button of the station 1100. The networking system of station 1100 is transmit the status
of the station 1100 to the gate keeper periodically. And the gate keeper is also multi-cast the status of
station 1100 to other networking system periodically. Then the BLF button of station 4100, 5111, 6210
is updating the status of station 1100 to its BLF LED.
STN 4100
STN 1100
STN 5111
STN 6210
Gate Keeper
Figure 2.16.12 The BLF operation on the networking configuration with the gate keeper.
Operation
The BLF manager software periodically receives the status of station from whole system.
notice) UDP port will be used to send the status information, and TCP port will be used to send
other information..
The BLF manager software sends the broadcast message to whole system when the status is
changed.
185
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
The BLF manager should be installed at one system for whole networked systems.
The number of Net DSS can be restricted according to the capability of each system.
When a flexible button on a station is assigned as the [NET DSS] button of another system, the
system serves as local BLF to indicate the status of the station.
CO BLF is not supported, and also ringing signal does not update a status of that station. – ICM /
CO / Transfer / CO Recall ring.
When a station is in DND mode, the [NET DSS] of DND station is flashing.
If the BLF manager does not exist, BLF services can be activated between only two systems. The
address of gatekeeper should be registered the address of each other system.
Admin Programming
Networking Supplementary Attribute 4.12.2 (PGM 321)
TCP Port Assign (FLEX 2) 4.12.2.2
UDP Port Assign (FLEX 3) 4.12.2.3
BLF manager IP Address Assign (FLEX 4) 4.12.2.4
Duration of BLF Status (FLEX 5) 4.12.2.5
Application
BLF Manager software (PC Application)
Description
A user from one system can activate a Follow-Me-Forward from a station on another system within the
network.
Once activated, all calls to the forwarded station will be forwarded to the forwarding station over the
network.
The forward can only be cancelled from the forwarded station.
Operation
To activate Net Call Forward- Follow-Me
1. From the station that the calls will be forwarded to:
2. Press the [SPEAKER] + [DND/FOR] button
3. Dial the Follow-Me-Forward code “0” + the station number that is to be call-forwarded from
another system.
4. Dial the authorization code and ‘#’ (end mark of authorization code. If 5 digits authorization
code mode, ‘#’ is no need.).
5. The [DND/FOR] button will be flashing on the forwarding station and a confirmation tone will
be provided if allowed.
All call to the forwarding station will be routed to the forwarded station.
Condition
186
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Programming
Authorization Code Table – PGM 227
Description
The SMDR call records from the Master system will include the station number from the slave system
(NET-Number) on CO Transit-In and CO Transit-Out calls.
Operation
1. The NET-Number will be included in the Centralized SMDR output for CO Transit-In and CO
Transit-Out calls
Condition
1. Up to 4 digits can be displayed in the station column.
2. Only applies to ISDN CO lines on the Master system.
Lines 0028 & 0029 show the resultant printout for an incoming CO Transit-In call to station
200 on the Slave. ISDN Line 006 was used for the incoming call and VOIP Line 011 was used
between systems. The NET-Number (200) is displayed as the “Outgoing Number” from the
Master system to the Slave.
2.17 2B Function
187
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
This feature allows to connect secondary devices to a primary station. To extend a primary, the
additional device is connected directly to a primary station with a 2B module. There are 3 kinds of 2B
module that can be used with some LKD model stations – DTIU, SLIU. One type(DTIU) allows of the
addition of a second DKTU, the other(SLIU) allows of the addition of SLT devices (station, fax, answer
microphone or modem).
Operation
Because the second device required the additional power, a small power supply is needed at the 2B
module when the distance between primary station and second device is long.
STA 102
STA 103
IP LDK System
Condition
1. This feature is available at LKD model stations(with 8/30/44 button) and SLIU, DTIU 2B option
modules are needed.
2. The maximum station capacity of the system is the same even if the 2B phone is used.
3. In LDK system, one station is designed as one voice channel. To use 2B feature, the primary
station should be connected to an odd port. When DKTU with 2B option is installed, the next port
should not be used.
4. The second station operates as the same with a normal station. But, the second SLT is not
available for the message wait lamp.
188
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
The system can monitor and print various system activities based on the main attendant's request(see
Ref.1). The information can be used to;
z Monitor and evaluate system performance
z Observe current usage and take corrective actions, if needed.
z Anticipate possible CO line problems
z Determine system updates and upgrades
The traffic data is output to the RS-232C or LAN. LDK system will support the following traffic reports.
z Attendant Traffic Report
z Call Summary Report
z Call Hourly Report
z H/W Unit Usage Summary Report
z CO line Traffic Summary Report
z CO line Traffic Hourly Report
Operation
The traffic analysis is only available at main attendant. Refer to the “Attendant Programming Menu
Table”. The measurement time type can be one of Today’s peak time, Yesterday’s peak time, Last hour,
Yesterday’s total and Today’s total.
Reference
1. Attendant : 2.13
Condition
1. This feature is available at main attendant.
189
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
2. The Printing of all summary service will generate attendant traffic report, call summary report, H/W
unit usage summary report, and CO traffic summary report.
Admin Programming
Print Port Selection 4.4.16 (PGM 175)
Description
LDK system supports the following report to analyze the attendant resource.
Operation
To print the Attendant Traffic Report at main attendant,
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Dial 0124.
3. Select Measurement Time type.
4. Press the [HOLD/SAVE] button.
Ex)
==========================================================================
190
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Site Name :
Report Type : Attendant Traffic Report - Yesterday Total
Date : 02/12/04 13:14
==========================================================================
Atd Meas --------- Calls --------- ------- Time ------ Time Speed Atd
No Hour Total Ans Abnd H-Abd Held Avail Talk Held NoAns Ans Type
Description
LDK system supports the following report to analyze the call status of the system.
- Analysis Start Hour – Starting time of hour duration which the data is recorded
- Number of Calls Completed – The total number of calls completed or answered during the listed
hour.
Operation
To print the Call Summary Report at main Attendant,
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Dial 0125.
Ex)
==========================================================================
Site Name :
Report Type : Call Summary Report
Date : 02/12/04 13:14
==========================================================================
Analysis Start Hour Number of Calls Completed
Last Hour 13:00 14
191
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
LDK system supports the following report to analyze the traffics of CO line group.
CO Traffic Summary Report
This report helps user to understand the traffic status of CO group by showing their statistics. You can
choose one of the followings; time duration, today’s peak time, yesterday’s peak time, last hour,
yesterday’s total and today’s total. It provides the following information field.
- Peak Hour for All CO Groups – The time duration (hour) in a day that has the largest total
usage when summed over all CO groups.
- Group Number – A number that identifies each CO group associated with the displayed data.
Group numbers are displayed in numeric order, beginning with the lowest number and continuing
to the highest one.
- Number of CO – The number of CO line in the group
- Analysis Start Hour – The time (24-hour mode) taking the measurement.
- Total Usage – Total usage for all CO lines in the CO group. It represents the total time that the
CO lines are busy during the measurement period. Total usage measures each time when a CO
line is seized for use by an incoming call or an outgoing call.
- Total Attempt – The number of incoming and outgoing call attempt in the CO group
- Incoming Attempt – The number of incoming call attempt in the CO group.
- Outgoing Attempt – The number of outgoing call attempt in the CO group.
- Group Overflow – The number of calls offered to a CO group that are not carried. Rejected calls
for authorization will not be included.
- Percentage All CO Busy – The percentage of time that all CO lines in the CO group are
simultaneously in use during the time interval.
- Percentage Fail to Attempt Outgoing – The percentage of offered calls that are not carried on
the CO group. It will not be included unauthorized calls which are denied on the CO group or
uncompleted calls carried on the CO group (unanswered calls).
Operation
CO Traffic Hourly Report
This report may analyze CO traffic patterns by showing the last 24 hour’s per hour CO traffic.
To print the CO Traffic Summary Report at main Attendant,
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Dial 0128.
3. Select Measurement Time type.
4. Press the [HOLD/SAVE] button.
192
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Ex)
===========================================================================
Site Name :
Report Type : CO Group Summary Report - Yesterday Total
Date : 02/12/04 13:15
===========================================================================
Peak Hour For All CO: 10:00
Grp Num Anal Total Total Inc. Out. Grp % %
No COs Hour Usage Seize Seize Seize Ovfl ACB FAO
1 62 --:-- 1319 1050 269 781 0 0 ---
Description
LDK system supports the following report to analyze the usage of HW unit resources of the system
such as Tone Receiver, VMIB.
Operation
To print the H/W Unit Usage Summary Report at main Attendant,
1. Press the [TRANS/PGM] button.
2. Dial 0127.
3. Select Measurement Time type.
4. Press the [HOLD/SAVE] button.
Ex)
===========================================================================
Site Name :
Report Type : H/W Unit Usage Summary Report - Yesterday Total
Date : 02/12/04 13:15
===========================================================================
Unit Num Anal Total Total
Type Unit Hour Req Denied
VMIB 4 --:-- 27 0
DTMF 13 --:-- 27 0
CPTU 12 --:-- 27 0
193
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
[Example]
PSTN
Modem
LAN
RS-232C(Serial)
ISDN
Figure 2.19.1 The connection of LDK system and PC for Software Upgrade
The figure 2.19.1 describes that there are 4 types of the connection of LDK system and PC for LDK
MPB software - SERIAL/ISDN/LAN/MODEM.
2.19.1 ISDN
Description
The LDK MPB software can be upgraded through ISDN BRI line interface by LDK upgrade program in
remote PC.
Operation
1. Connect the ISDN phone line to the PC ISDN card.
2. Connect the ISDN T-interface line to a BRI port of LDK system.
3. Run LDK PC Upgrade program.
4. Select the LDK system to be upgraded and press ‘OK’ button.
194
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
5. Set the port type to “ISDN Connection”. And press the ‘Select’ button.
6. Enter the ISDN phone number, path of the binary file, and the password for upgrade. And press
the ‘Next’ button.
7. In the ‘Next’ window, press ‘Start’ button. You can see the LDK MPB software upgrade process.
8. When the ROM file sending is finished in the PC, LDK will erase the previous ROM data and start
to fill LDK ROM area with the received ROM file.
195
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
1. The ISDN card in the PC should support CAPI (Common-ISDN Application Programming
Interface) 2.0 which is a standard interface specification devised to use ISDN channels in the PC.
Also, it should support HDLC as a B channel protocol. And “CAPI2032.DLL” should be found in the
“System” directory of “Windows” which means that the CAPI driver for Windows is properly
installed.
2. If the line is DID type, you should make a call to any station or station group except ISDN station
(S port). Only the call in this case will be accepted by LDK system.
3. When the line is released while upgrading process, just dial the phone number again. If the line
was properly disconnected, it will be connected immediately.
4. While upgrading process, other features do not work in the system.
5. When the LDK MPB software upgrade is finished without completing, you can retry to upgrade by
doing the whole process again.
6. If the ROM files you want to send are invalid, LDK MPB software upgrade will not be started.
7. DRAM should be installed on the MPB to use this feature.
2.19.2 LAN
Description
The LDK MPB software can be upgraded through LAN interface by LDK upgrade program in remote
PC.
Operation
1. Connect the LAN cable to the PC LAN-card.
2. Run LDK PC Upgrade program.
3. Select the LDK system to be upgraded and press ‘OK’ button.
196
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
4. Set the port type to “TCP Connection”. And press the ‘Select’ button.
5. Enter the LDK IP address, path of the binary file and the password for upgrade. And press the
‘Next’ button.
6. In the ‘Next’ window, press ‘Start’ button. You can see the LDK MPB software upgrade process.
7. When the ROM file sending is finished in the PC, LDK will erase the previous ROM data and start
to fill LDK ROM area with the received ROM file.
Condition
1. When the line is released while upgrading process, just dial the phone number again. If the line
was properly disconnected, it will be connected immediately.
2. While upgrading process, other features do not work in the system.
3. When the LDK MPB software upgrade is finished without completing, you can retry to upgrade by
doing the whole process again.
4. If the ROM files you want to send are invalid, LDK MPB software upgrade will not be started.
5. DRAM should be installed on the MPB to use this feature.
Admin Programming
IP Setting for MPB 3.2.8 (PGM 108)
197
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Description
The LDK MPB software can be upgraded through RS-232C interface by LDK upgrade program in the
PC.
Operation
1. Connect the RS-232C cable between LDK system and PC.
2. Run LDK PC Upgrade program.
3. Select the LDK system to be upgraded and press ‘OK’ button
4. Set the port type to “Serial Connection”. And press the ‘Select’ button.
5. Enter the path of binary file, serial port number, serial port baud rate, and the password for
upgrade. And press the ‘Next’ button.
198
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
6. In the ‘Next’ window, press ‘Start’ button. You can see the LDK MPB software upgrade process.
7. When the ROM file sending is finished in the PC, LDK will erase the previous ROM data and start
to fill LDK ROM area with the received ROM file.
Condition
1. While upgrading process, other features do not work in the system.
2. When the LDK MPB software upgrade is finished without completing, you can retry to upgrade by
doing the whole process again.
3. If the ROM files you want to send are invalid, LDK MPB software upgrade will not be started.
4. Serial port should be connected to COM port 2 in the MPB.
5. DRAM should be installed on the MPB to use this feature.
Admin Programming
RS-232C Port Setting 4.4.15 (PGM 174)
2.19.4 MODEM
Description
The LDK MPB software can be upgraded through Modem interface by LDK upgrade program in
remote PC.
Operation
1. Run LDK PC Upgrade program.
2. Select the LDK system to be upgraded and press ‘OK’ button.
199
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
3. Set the port type to “Modem Connection”. And press the ‘Select’ button.
4. Enter the LDK dial number, the path of binary file and the password for upgrade. And press the
‘Next’ button.
200
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Feature
Condition
1. When the line is released while upgrading process, retry the LDK PC Upgrade program again. y.
2. While upgrading process, other features do not work in the system.
3. When the LDK MPB software upgrade is finished without completing, you can retry to upgrade by
doing the whole process again.
4. If the ROM files you want to send are invalid, LDK MPB software upgrade will not be started.
5. DRAM should be installed on the MPB to use this feature.
Admin Programming
Modem ASC Device 4.4.11 (PGM 170)
201
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Basic ADMIN programming
The LDK System can be programmed to meet each customer's individual need.
All programming is done at station 100 (station port # 00) using KD-36D or LKD-
30/44 digital key telephone. (You cannot program with Large LCD DKTU.)
Additional programming stations may be assigned (PGM 113 – FLEX 1), but only 1
DKTU can be active in programming mode at any one time.
Upon entering the program mode, the station 100 cannot operate as a normal
telephone but as a programming instrument with all of the buttons redefined. The keys
of the dial pad are used to enter the various data fields and to enter numerical
information. The 24 buttons located at the top of the phone (Flexible Buttons) are used
to indicate the specific data field and to enter information. Sometimes the [SPEED]
button and ‘*’ of the dial pad is used to delete the data or to indicate end of data input
and the [REDIAL] button is used to delete one digit or character from the end of entered
digits or characters.
202
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Basic ADMIN programming
FLEX 3
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
.
FLEX 30
Microphone
There are many kinds of DKTU connecting to the LDK system. This model of LKD-30D is an
sample that just shows each button. The detailed information about DKTU and other keyset
is described in “DKTU USER GUIDE and INSTALLATION MANUAL”.
203
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Basic ADMIN programming
NOTE :
1. The step 2, “[TRANS/PGM] Î Î # ”, is omitted from the procedure in
section 3 and section 4.
2. To return the parent state while ADMIN programming, press the [CONF]
button. Pressing the [CONF] button, temporary data fields are cleared.
204
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Basic ADMIN programming
3.6 Pre-programming
This section describes the pre-programming of the data. When installed, user must program some
database (Ex. Nationality, Numbering Plan Type, and Slot Assignment) first, otherwise system may not
operate properly.
Station number, a cipher of CO line, each feature codes at LDK System are assigned for default value.
User can change Station number, a cipher of CO line(2~4 figures), feature codes to appropriate to
user circumstance.
Feature codes of the system can be assigned flexibly via the system programming. Feature Code
length should be in the range of 1(one) digit through 4 digits. Let's say that a feature code conflict has
occurred in such case that a feature code string matches with other longer feature code string,
checking from the first digit of the code. For example, features Code 53 and 536 have a feature code
conflict. The system will not allow any feature code conflict
* Note: If you change the numbering plan type at ADMIN 104, you have to reload flexible number plan
– Station number (PGM105) information. If you don’t reload that information, you would find some mis-
operation in checking the range.
IP address, Subnet mask, and Gateway address should be programmed for trace, remote upgrade,
PC ADMIN, PC Attendant, etc via network.
205
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Basic ADMIN programming
PROCEDURE
3.6.1.1 Nation Code
Q – 11 A - 21 D - 31
Z – 12 B - 22 E - 32
. – 13 C - 23 F - 33
1 – 10 2 - 20 3 - 30
G – 41 J - 51 M - 61
H - 42 K - 52 N - 62
I - 43 L - 53 O - 63
4 – 40 5 - 50 6 - 60
P - 71 W - 91
T - 81
R - 72 X - 92
U - 82
S - 73 Y - 93
V - 83
Q - 7* Z - 9#
8 - 80
7 – 70 9 - 90
*1 - Blank
*2 - : 0-00 #
*3 - ,
206
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Basic ADMIN programming
207
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Basic ADMIN programming
PROCEDURE
STA CODE COL CODE STA & COL CODE Etc CODE
DTIB4 11 LCOB2 33 STIB2 52 VMIB 61
DTIB8 12 LCOB4 34 STIB1 53 AAFB 62
SLIB4 13 CBIB 54 VMIBE 64
SLIB8 14 AAFBE 65
Board type of basic MBU(Slot 1- Slot3, Slot5) and VMIB slot (slot 7) can not be changed.
- Slot 1: Hybrid on MBU.
- Slot 2: not used
- Slot 3: not used in ISDN type MBU(SLIB4 in Analog type MBU).
- Slot 4: optional STA board.
- Slot 5: CO board on MBU.
- Slot 6: optional CO slot.
- Slot 7: VMIB slot.
- Slot 8: SLIM/DTIM slot.
- Slot 9: VOIM slot.
PROCEDURE
3.6.4.1 COL Board
208
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Basic ADMIN programming
Description
There’re 8 Numbering Plan Type. Each type has different default value at each Numbering Plan Code.
Intercom Range of ADMIN105 is described below. For Flexible Numbering Plan of ADMIN 106 and
ADMIN 107, Refer to 5.3.6.
PROCEDURE
209
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Basic ADMIN programming
LCD
000 001 002 003 (1) [TRANS/PGM] + 105.
100 101 102 103
000 001 002 003 z Station Number Assign. You will see the 4 station numbers
100 101 102 103 corresponding to the 4 port numbers. Station number length is in the
range of 2 digits through 4 digits. There are two methods for
changing station number.
Dial two station numbers - Range start station number & range end
station number, then LCD shows dialed range value. Press the
[HOLD/SAVE] button, then station numbers changed from the first
station number on current LCD to range end (All LEDs of FELX buttons
are off.).
Press one of FLEX 1-4 (Each FLEX 1-4 is assigned to station number 1-
4 on the current LCD), then LED of pressed Flex button is steady on.
Dial new station number and press the [HOLD/SAVE] button, or press
other Flex button to assign station number to other station without
saving (The LED of pressed Flex. button is on.).
If you want to delete all station numbers, press the [SPEED] button and
press [HOLD/SAVE] button, then all station numbers are cleared.
If you want to change next 4 station numbers then press [▼] button. If
you want to change previous 4 station numbers, then press [▲] button.
000 001 002 003 (2) Press the [HOLD/SAVE] button for saving database permanently. (Ex:
100 400 102 103 Press FLEX 2, dial 400 and press [HOLD/SAVE] button.)
210
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Basic ADMIN programming
Description
By dialing Feature Code, the proper feature is activated.
PROCEDURE
DEFAULT VALUE
FLEX ITEM
(at Numbering Plan Type 1)
1 Station Group Pilot Number Range 620 – 629
2 Internal Page Zone Number Range 501 – 510
3 Internal All Call Page 543
4 Meet Me Page 544
5 External Page Zone - 1 545
6 All Call Page (Internal/External) 549
7 SMDR Account Code 550
8 Flash Command to CO Line 551
9 Last Number Redial (LNR) 552
10 Do-Not-Disturb 553
11 Call Forward 554
12 Speed Dial Program 555
13 MSG Wait/Call-Back Enable 556
14 MSG Wait/Call-Back Answer 557
15 Speed Dial Access 558
16 Cancel DND/CFW/Pre-selected MSG Features 559
17 System Hold 560
18 Reserved
19 Reserved
20 SLT Program Mode Select 563
21 ACD Reroute 564
211
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Basic ADMIN programming
DEFAULT VALUE
FLEX ITEM
(at Numbering Plan Type 1)
1 Alarm Reset 565
2 Group Call Pick-Up 566
3 UCD Group DND 568
4 Night Answer 569
5 Call Park Location Range 601 – 608
6 Direct Call Pick-Up 7
801 – 808
7 Access CO Line Group
(8 + CO Group Number)
8 Access Individual CO Line 8801 – 8816(88 + CO Line Number)
9 Tie Routing Access 8901
10 Access Held CO Line Group 8*
8#01 – 8#16
11 Access Held Individual CO Line
(8# + CO Line Number)
12 Access to CO line in the 1st available CO Line Group 9(or 0, depend on a nation)
13 Attendant Call 0(or 9, depend on a nation)
14 Door Open – 1 #*1
15 Door Open – 2 #*2
16 VM MSG Wait Enable *8
17 VM MSG Wait Cancel *9
212
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Basic ADMIN programming
PROCEDURE
3.6.8.1 IP Name
. – 13 A – 21 D – 31
Q – 11 B – 22 E – 32
Z – 12 C – 23 F – 33
1 – 10 2 – 20 3 – 30
G – 41 J – 51 M – 61
H – 42 K – 52 N – 62
I – 43 L – 53 O – 63
4 – 40 5 – 50 6 – 60
P – 71 W – 91
T – 81
R – 72 X – 92
U – 82
S – 73 Y – 93
V – 83
Q - 7½ Z – 9#
8 – 80
7 – 70 9 – 90
½1–Blank
½2 - : 0 – 00 #
½3 - ,
213
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Basic ADMIN programming
214
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual System Basic ADMIN programming
+ 250 +
(PGM NUMBER)
215
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
NOTE :
1. The step 2, “[TRANS/PGM] Î Î # ”, is omitted from the procedure in
ADMIN Programming.
2. To return the parent state while ADMIN programming, press the [CONF]
button. Pressing the [CONF] button, temporary data fields are cleared.
This table is frequently used in ADMIN Programming procedure. As you can see from
the table, there are 3 items “ Station range, CO range, CO Line group Range”.
When entering each range, refer to the table because the range is not mentioned.
216
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
At ADMIN program 110 – FLEX 1, Station ID can be set. Then Station ID is changed to the desired
value which is different from default value(i.e : normal DKTU /normal SLT).
PROCEDURE(Station ID)
DKTU ID
Station ID
01 : DKTU
02 : DSS MAP 1
03 : DSS MAP 2
04 : DSS MAP 3
05 : ICM BOX
06 : RESERVED
07 : SLT(DTMF)
08 : SLT(PULSE)
09 : RESERVED
10 : RESERVED
11 : ISDN Phone
217
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
To use DSS/DLS, assign its ID after pressing FLEX 1. Then set associated station number after
pressing FLEX 2. One station can have multiple DSS/DLS maps up to 3. These DSS/DLS should
have their ID sequentially (i.e. DSS MAP1, DSS MAP2, …).
DSS MAP1
+ + STATION NUMBER +
218
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If this value is set to ON, Station user can access a CO line or make a DSS call by pressing
appropriate {CO} or {DSS} button without lifting handset or pressing the [MON] button.
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to ON, an incoming call can be forwarded to the other destination.
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. Call Forward : 2.3.1
4.1.2.3 DND
Description
PROCEDURE
219
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If this value is set to ON, override and camp-on from other stations are prohibited when this station is
busy.
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. Attendant override : 2.13.5
2. Camp-on : 2.4.5
Description
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to ON, This station can receive intercom box signal.
PROCEDURE
220
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If this value is set to ON, the station can be responded to the transferred CO call automatically when
station mode is H/P.
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. Headset : 2.4.13
Description
If this value is set to ON, This station can page to other station.
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. Paging feature : 2.8
Description
If this value is not 0, this ring type is heard to called party station of intercom call.
Value : 0 ~ 4
PROCEDURE
221
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This feature determines the ringing path whether Speaker or Headset and even both.
PROCEDURE
4.1.2.11 Speakerphone
Description
PROCEDURE
Description
This feature selects intercom Tenancy Group, which this station belongs to.
Value : 01~05
PROCEDURE
ICM Group 02
Reference
1. Intercom Tenancy Group : 2.4.15
222
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If this value is set to ON, and TAD is used in SLT port, when the caller hangs up, busy tone will be
provided to TAD instead of error tone.
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to ON, CO Call is dropped by pressing [FLASH] button or Hook Flashing
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to ON, station user must enter Account Code to use Loop LCR.
PROCEDURE
PROCEDURE
1. LCR(Least Call Routing) : 2.2.7
2. Account Code : 2.5.1
223
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
In FIFO state, the first recorded VMIB message can play. Oppositely in LIFO state, the latest
message plays.
PROCEDURE
Description
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. SLT Call Forward : 2.3.1.8
Description
If this value is set to ON, the caller can make the called party in ring mode to hands free mode
forcedly
PROCEDURE
224
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
PROCEDURE
Description
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to ON, the station can make Voice-Over to busy station.
Value : ON=1/OFF=0
PROCEDURE
225
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
In case of restricting outgoing CO call time, if this value is set to ON, the station user receives
warning tone during CO call after the timer expires(ADMIN 180-FLEX 22).
PROCEDURE
Description
While seizing a CO line, the station user seizes another CO line by pressing the {CO} button. If this
value is set to ON, the previous seized CO line goes on hold automatically. In case of Attendant ,
default value is ON.
PROCEDURE
Description
If this flag is set to ON, station’s outgoing CO call may be disconnected when CO call restriction timer
(PGM 180-FLEX 17) expires.
PROCEDURE
Description
226
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
If this value is set to ENABLE, the station user can access individual CO line by dialing Individual CO
access code(ADMIN 107-FLEX 8)
PROCEDURE
Description
When a user of station receives a busy signal during an attempt to access a CO line, the user may
request a call back (queue) when the CO Line is available. If this value is set to ENABLE, the user
gets the recalling from the CO Line when it’s available.
PROCEDURE
4.1.3.6 CO PGM
Description
If this value is set to ENABLE, the station user can program CO button at its Flexible button.
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. Flexible Button : 2.4.12
4.1.3.7 PLA
Description
227
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
If this value is set to ENABLE, the station user can answer calls according to the priority (ADMIN
173).
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to ON, the station user can use Prepaid Call feature.
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to ENABLE, the station user can use system speed dial call.
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. System Speed Dialing : 2.2.8.5
Description
228
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
If this value is set to ON, the station user can record the incoming and outgoing voice during
conversation.
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. Two-way Recording: 2.11.3
Description
If this value is set to ON, single ring is provided and Attendant recall is not operated.
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to EXT, the station user can only forward CO call to Off-net(ex mobile phone).
Otherwise both CO call and ICM call can be forwarded to Off-net.
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. Call Forward, Station Off-net : 2.3.1.5
Description
229
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
Description
This feature is used when a station in Ring Group gets a DID/DISA call.
If this value is set to ON, the Ring Group, which the station belongs to, gets the incoming call and if
this value is set to OFF, the station gets the incoming call directly
PROCEDURE
Description
PROCEDURE
Description
230
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
This feature is used to distinguish the line length when the distance between the stations and the
station boards is too variable. (SAF only)
PROCEDURE
Description
This value means the scroll speed of SMS or broadcasting notice message. (Only for LKD-30DH)
Value : 0~7
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to ON, SLT recalling is blocked after pressing [FLASH] button.
PROCEDURE
231
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If this value is set to ON, the conversation time of incoming CO call is limited.
After CO Call Restriction Timer is expired, the call is forced to disconnected.
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. CO Call Restriction Timer : 4.5.1.17
Description
If this value is set to ON, the password is needed to access outgoing CO access.
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to ON,. busy station can receive call indication if another new call is entered
through analog PSTN line.
PROCEDURE
Description
232
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
If this value is set to ENABLE,. Station can open the door with dialing Door Open Code.
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to ON, this station goes to a dummy station, so a hot-desk agent can login at the
dummy station.
PROCEDURE
Reference
Hot Desk
4.1.4.1 ADMIN
Description
If this value is set to ENABLE, the assigned station users can program ADMIN Database. This
feature is only available at DKTU.
(STA 100 : Enabled as default)
PROCEDURE
Description
233
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
If this value is set to ENABLE, the station user can use VMIB.
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to ENABLE, the station user can use group listening. While you are talking on
handset, by pressing the [MON] button, other people around you may hear the conversation through
the speaker. Although the voice of other people is not sent by Mic.
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to ENABLE, the station user can override CO Call.
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. Attendant Override : 2.13.5
Description
234
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
If this value is set to ENABLE, Dialed number of CO Call is not showed on SMDR record
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. SMDR : 2.12
Description
If this value is set to ENABLE, the station user can talk alternately a call to the other call.
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. Voice Over : 2.4.26
Description
If this value is set to HOT, the station user can use Hot Line. (Ref ADMIN 122).
Otherwise in Warm Line state, Warm Line Timer starts when the user lifts handset or presses the
[MON] button.
PROCEDURE
235
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If this value is set to ON, the station user must enter password to retrieve VMIB Message.
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. Recording System VMIB Announcement : 2.11.1
Description
If this value is set to ON, Date and time will be heard when VMIB Message is retrieved.
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. Recording System VMIB Announcement : 2.11.1
Description
If this value is set to ON, the station gets the alarm signal.
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. Alarm : 2.4.1
236
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If this value is set to ON, the CLI is displayed on the station’s LCD.
( CO Line Name is not displayed when CLIP is set to ON.)
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. CLI(Calling Line Identification Presentation) : 2.14.2
Description
If this value is set to ON, the connected party’s CLI is displayed on station’s LCD.
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. CLI(Calling Line Identification Presentation) : 2.14.2
Description
When using networking, If this value is set to RED, the redirected CLI is displayed. Otherwise, the
original CLI is displayed
PROCEDURE
Reference
237
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If this value is set to ON, the station can receive CLI message from CO Incoming call,
when the station doesn’t answer.
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. CLI(Calling Line Identification Presentation) : 2.14.2
Description
If this value is set to ATD, CO ATD code(ADMIN 200) is used to outgoing CLI information. Otherwise,
station number is used as CLI information
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. CLI(Calling Line Identification Presentation) : 2.14.2
Description
If this value is set to KEYPAD, ISDN station sends digit in keypad facility after connected. Otherwise
DTMF is used.
PROCEDURE
238
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
4.1.5.7 Long/Short
Description
If this value is set to LONG, ISDN station acts in LONG passive mode.
PROCEDURE
Description
Value : 0~2
- 0: Do not send CPN (Called Party Number) to S0. In this case, all S0 stations of the S port will be
ringing.
- 1: Send station number as CPN
- 2: Bypass CPN from the network.
PROCEDURE
Description
Value : 0~2
- 0: Station sub-address not used.
239
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
Description
If this field is ON, the system checks whether the received CLI is matched with the speed dial data or
not. If it is matched, the speed dial name is displayed.
PROCEDURE
Description
This value is used as outgoing CLI When outgoing CLI is active and CLI type is EXT(Station)
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to ON, the Progress Indicator can notice non-ISDN device.
PROCEDURE
240
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to ON, the connect party’s CLI information is restricted by PX.
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to ON, the station is restricted to receive the DID incoming call.
PROCEDURE
241
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If this value is set to ON, when the station is busy, another DID call could be waiting.
PROCEDURE
Description
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. Long Station CLI : 4.1.5.18
2. ISDN CLI STA : 4.1.5.11
Description
If outgoing CLI is activated and CLI type is EXT(Station), this value is used as outgoing CLI.
PROCEDURE
242
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If this value is set to ON,. A busy station can receive a call waiting signal when another MSN call is
entered.
PROCEDURE
Description
PROCEDURE
Reference
Description
PROCEDURE
Reference
243
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
PROCEDURE
In case of the assignment of CO Line Group Button
244
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
12 {LOOP} {LOOP}
13 - 24 - Not assigned
TABLE Initial Button Configuration (PGM 115)
Description
Each station is assigned to COS(Class Of Service) which determine station's toll restriction for the day
and night operation. For a particular call, the CO COS is combined with station COS to determine
restriction. All stations’ COS for day and night operation are 1 as default. The weekend COS is the
same as night COS.
PROCEDURE
+ 2(COS) +
(NIGHT)
245
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
Each stations has a right of accessibility to CO Line group. The right could be changed by ADMIN
programming.
The access ability to CO Line Group1 is offered as default for all stations. Accessibility to multiple CO
Line Group is possible.
PROCEDURE
(Range: FLEX1~FLEX8)
Reference
1. CO line Group 4.2.2.1
Description
PROCEDURE
246
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
Default value :
Default assigns all stations to None.
FLEX DEFAULT VALUE REMARK
- 1-5 Conference Page Zone (Toggle)
PROCEDURE
Description
Each Intercom Tenancy Group can be operated independently and the stations in the group can be
assigned an individual CO Line Group to use. Each group can be assigned with attendant and can be
programmed to allow or deny calls to other groups.
247
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
Each ICM group may have one attendant.
Day / Night Mode of ICM Group is set by ICM Group attendant.
Description
Description
When this feature is programmed, If the station does not answer the incoming CO call within Preset
Call Forward timer, then this call is forwarded to preset destination.
No station is assigned as default.
PROCEDURE
Forward to Station.
248
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This feature assigns the destination of Hot Line and Warm Line.(Ref 2.2.6 Hot Line & Warm Line)
PROCEDURE
Description
Stations can be assigned as a member of call account group on SMDR. A station belongs to only one
group.
Value : 00~99
- Account Group : 00~23 (LDK- 20)
PROCEDURE
Description
The assigned DSS button can be copied to another station or ICM group.
249
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
Copy DSS from Station.
Description
COS stands for Class of Service. It means, defends on the grade of COS, the service could be
limited.
The certain COS of station could be checked.
PROCEDURE
Show Station by assigned Day COS
Description
250
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Station Numbers which can access in certain CO Line Group could be checked.
PROCEDURE
To change the value, user can do as follows.
+ 131 + 01( CO LINE GROUP) (LCD shows stations that are assigned to
access CO Line Group 1)
Next page : Volume Down
Previous step: [CONF]
Description
4.2.1.1 Normal CO
PROCEDURE
251
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
To use DISA Service, previously, CO type is set to only Normal CO. Then, execute below procedure
continually.
Reference
1. Normal CO : 4.2.1.1
2. VMIB announcement : 2.11
Description
PROCEDURE
252
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
4.2.2.2 CO COS
Description
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. COS(Class Of Service) : 2.5.4
Description
If this value is set to ON, when the incoming CO caller tries to access another CO Line by dialing CO
Line access code, the caller should enter authorization code.
This is applied only when this CO Service type is DISA.
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. CO SERVICE TYPE : 4.2.1
2. DISA(Direct Inward System Access) : 2.1.4
3. Authorization Code : 2.5.2
253
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If this value is set to ON, Polarity Reverse is applied to the CO Line, otherwise, Loop Start is applied
to.
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to PBX, the opposite system is PBX. Oppositely if it is set to CO, the system is
Central Office.
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to DTMF, the CO Line signaling type is set to DTMF.
Otherwise, signaling type is set to Pulse.
PROCEDURE
254
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
PROCEDURE
Description
If this feature is set to ON, Universal Night Answer service is applied to this CO Line.
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. UNA (UNIVERSAL NIGHT ANSWER) : 2.1.7
Description
If this value is set to ON, the CO Line user should enter authorization code to access this CO Line.
PROCEDURE
255
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Reference
1. Authorization Code : 2.5.2
Description
This value means ICM Tenancy group number the station belongs to. This station receives the CO
Call.
If this value is set, separated Day/Night ring mode is applied to the incoming CO Call according to
each ICM tenancy group attendant’s Day/Night ring mode.
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. Day/Night service : 2.13.8
Description
If this value is set to ON and the CO Line Name is assigned, the Name is displayed on the station
LCD when the station gets the CO incoming call through this CO Line.
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. CO Line Name Assign : 4.2.3.2
Description
256
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
. – 13 A – 21 D – 31
Q – 11 B – 22 E – 32
Z – 12 C – 23 F – 33
1 – 10 2 – 20 3 – 30
G – 41 J – 51 M – 61
H – 42 K – 52 N – 62
I – 43 L – 53 O – 63
4 – 40 5 – 50 6 – 60
P – 71 W – 91
T – 81
R – 72 X – 92
U – 82
S – 73 Y – 93
V – 83
Q - 7½ Z – 9#
8 – 80
7 – 70 9 – 90
½1–Blank
½2 - : 0 – 00 #
½3 - ,
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. CO Line Name Display : 4.2.3.1
Description
This value determines the Unit used to perceive a pulse from CO Line.
PROCEDURE
257
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If this value is set to ON, CPT checks the incoming CO Line when answered and if CPT detects dial
tone, then system drops the line for toll restriction.
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is not set to 0, the designated ring tone is heard to the station when the station gets the
incoming CO Call so that the user can distinguish incoming CO Call and ICM Call with its different
ring tone. Each ring tone can be adjusted at ADMIN 422
Value : 0 ~ 4
PROCEDURE
Description
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. MOH (Music On Hold) : 2.4.17
258
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
PROCEDURE
Description
PROCEDURE
Description
PROCEDURE
259
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
PROCEDURE
Description
Default value : No
PROCEDURE
Description
Value : 000~300
260
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
Description
Value : 00~20
PROCEDURE
Description
This feature is used to distinguish the line length when the CO Line length is too variable. (SAF only)
PROCEDURE
Description
PROCEDURE
261
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
Value : 00~50
- 00 ~49: PGM 201 Bin No
- 50: PGM 114-FLEX 5
PROCEDURE
Description
Value : 00~50
- 00 ~49: PGM 201 Bin No
- 50: PGM 114-FLEX 5
PROCEDURE
Description
This value is used to set the call type of ISDN CO line CLI.
262
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Value : 0~4
- 0: Unknown
- 1: International
- 2: National
- 3: Not used
- 4: Subscriber
PROCEDURE
Description
When CO Service Type is set to ISDN DID/MSN(ADMIN 140), this value is used to decide DID digit
conversion type.
If this value is set to 0, incoming digits are converted as ADMINN 146.
If set to 1, there’s no digit conversion. If the caller dials valid station number, the station gets the call.
If set to 2, it refers Flexible DID Table(ADMIN 231).
Value : 0~2
- 0: convert digits by DID Digit Conversion (PGM146)
- 1: call to the valid extension.
- 2: convert digits by Flex DID Table (PGM231)
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is not 0, and the CO Line is DID Line, the system discard the incoming DID digits up to
amount of this value .
e.g. If this value is set to 02 and the outside caller dialed ‘01245’, then the first ‘01’ is removed.
Value : 00~99
PROCEDURE
263
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If this value is set to ON, Enblock Sending Mode is applied at outgoing CO call.
PROCEDURE
Description
When using networking, If this value is set to ORI, the originate caller’s CLI is sent for CLI. Otherwise,
the call forwarded station’s CLI is sent.
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. Transit – In : 2.16.12
2. CO Transit – Out : 2.16.13
Description
This value is used for Numbering Plan Id of ISDN called and calling party number.
Value : 0~7
264
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
- 0: unknown
- 1: ISDN / TELEPHONY
- 2: NOT USED
- 3: DATA
- 4: TELEX
- 5: NOT USED
- 6: NATIONAL STANDARD
- 7: PRIVATE
PROCEDURE
1(ISDN/TELEPHONY) +
Description
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to ON, the first digit is removed. Italy only.
PROCEDURE
265
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If this value is set to ON, Inband info. in call proceeding is available. Italy only
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to 0, the CLI is made as before (refer PGM200/PGM114)
If this value is set to 1 or 2, the CLI is just as same as Long CLI (Station Long CLI 1 or 2).
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. Station Long CLI 1 (4.1.5.21)
2. Station Long CLI 2 (4.1.5.22)
Description
When CO Service Type(ADMIN 140) is set to Normal, CO incoming call goes to proper destination
according to this assignment.
Destination can be station or hunt group or VMIB announcement.
Ring assignment is applied separately by Day/Night Ring Mode by pressing FLEX 1~4.
Reference
1. Hunt Group : 2.6
2. Voice Service 2.11
3. Day/Night Ring Mode : 2.13.8
266
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
PROCEDURE
To Assign Ring to Station at Day Mode,
PROCEDURE
To Assign Ring to Station at Night Mode,
+ HUNT GROUP +
(RANGE: 620~629)
PROCEDURE
To Assign Ring to Station at Weekend Mode,
+ VOICE MESSAGE +
(RANGE: 00~70)
Description
267
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
You can check the ring assignment destination of the CO line for each Day/Night Ring Mode.
If CO Call is assigned to the station at Day or Night Mode, you can see the delay value also.
e.g.) 100(1) means station 100 gets the ring with delay 1.
When there are too many stations, you can scroll data using volume up/down key.
Description
If this value is set to ON, prefix code will be attached in front of incoming CLI.
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. My Area Prefix Code : 4.8.1.6
Description
If this value is set to ON, prefix code will be attached in front of outgoing CLI.
PROCEDURE
268
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Reference
1. My Area Prefix Code : 4.8.1.6
Description
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to ON, calling party sub-address of the ISDN station is attached when an ISDN
station makes an outgoing CO Call through this CO Line.
PROCEDURE
Description
This value is used as count of the received DID Digit number to route DID incoming Call.
Value : 2~4(Digits)
PROCEDURE
Description
269
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
When DID Conversion Type(ADMIN 143 – FLEX4) is set to 0, The received DID digits are converted
by this value.
The number 0 ~ 9, #, * can be entered.
# means to ignore received digit, and * means to bypass the digit.
The length of DID Digit Mask is 4.
e.g.) ‘1234’ is received when DID Digit Mask is set as ‘#8**’, the digit is converted as ‘834’.
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to RBT, ring back tone is provided to the station when the station calls busy
attendant. Otherwise hold tone or VMIB-MOH(ADMIN 171 - FLEX2) is provided.
PROCEDURE
+ 160 + + 1(RBT) +
Reference
1. MOH (Music On Hold) : 2.4.17
270
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 160 + + 1(RBT) +
Reference
1. MOH (Music On Hold) : 2.4.17
Description
In seizing a CO Line among CO line group, if this value is set to LAST CHOICE, Last available CO
Line is seized. Otherwise, CO line is seized round robin choice.
PROCEDURE
Description
When the DISA user fails to call a station or access a feature, then DISA user can retry other calls or
features within this retry counter. If DISA user cannot access appropriately within this counter, this
call is routed according to DID/DISA destination (ADMIN 167).
Value : 0~9
PROCEDURE
+ 160 + + 4 +
(Retry Counter)
271
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 160 + + 0(Discontinuous) +
Description
When the speed dial is activated, if this value is set to ON, system detects dial tone using CPT
instead of pause timer.
PROCEDURE
+ 160 + + 1(On) +
Description
If this value is set to ON, when CO incoming call is received and UNA service is activated, the call is
sent to LBC1.
PROCEDURE
+ 160 + + 0(On) +
272
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Reference
1. UNA (UNIVERSAL NIGHT ANSWER) : 2.1.7
Description
There are two types of Hold; System Hold and Exclusive Hold. If a call is held as System Hold, any
station can retrieve that call, Otherwise only holding station can retrieve that call.
PROCEDURE
+ 160 + + 0(Exclusive) +
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 160 + + 0(Off) +
Reference
1. Conference – SLT (BROKERS Call) : 2.7.1
Description
If this value is set to On, LCR converted digits are showed on LCD and SMDR data. Otherwise
original dialed digits are showed.
PROCEDURE
273
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
+ 160 + + 1(On) +
Reference
1. LCR(Least Call Routing) : 2.2.7
2. SMDR : 2.12
Description
If this value is set to ON, other members will hear warning tone when a new member enters the
conference,
PROCEDURE
+ 160 + + 0(Off) +
4.4.1.12 Off-net Prompt Usage
Description
If this value is set to On, off-net VMIB announcement(prompt) will be heard when the call is Off-net
call forwarded,. It is only applied to CO-to-CO Transfer.
PROCEDURE
+ 160 + + 0(Off) +
Reference
1. Call Forward, Incoming CO Off-net (ATD only) : 2.3.1.6
Description
If this value is set to ON, dialing DTMF tone will be heard to the outside caller when the call is Off-net
call forwarded. It is only applied to CO-to-CO Transfer.
PROCEDURE
274
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
+ 160 + + 0(Off) +
Reference
1. Call Forward, Incoming CO Off-net (ATD only) : 2.3.1.6
4.4.1.14 Voice Path Connect
Description
If this value is set to IMM(immediate), voice path is connected immediately at the CO outgoing call,
Otherwise It is connected after dialing any digits.
PROCEDURE
+ 160 + + 1(IMM) +
Description
While a call is transferred to destination station, if this value is set to RBT, transferred station will be
heard ring back tone. Otherwise MOH will be heard.
PROCEDURE
+ 160 + + 0(RBT) +
Reference
1. MOH (Music On Hold) : 2.4.17
Description
If this value is set to CPT detection, CO-CO transfer connection will be dropped when tone is
detected from CO-CO transfer connection. To detect tone from CO line, CPT detection board is
required.
PROCEDURE
275
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 160 + + ON +
Description
If this value is set to on, the conference call user can extend Unsupervised Conference Timer by
dialing UC TIMER EXTEND Code.
PROCEDURE
+ 160 + + ON +
Reference
1. Conference
2. UC Conference timer Extend Code
Description
Value : 15 ~ 50 (2 digits)
PROCEDURE
+ 160 + + 15 +
276
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If this value is set to ON, the system time/date are set by the network time/date.
PROCEDURE
+ 161 + + 1(On) +
Description
The off-hook ring type in the system can be set to mute or one burst ring.
PROCEDURE
+ 161 + + 0(Burst) +
Description
If this value is set to ON, if there is no available CO Line in the first CO Line Group, system can
access the next accessible CO Line Group.
PROCEDURE
+ 161 + + 0(Off) +
277
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If this value is set to ON, page warning tone will be heard when paging starts.
PROCEDURE
+ 161 + + 0(Off) +
Description
If this value is set to ON, the call is protected from override regardless of Station Override Privilege
(ADMIN 113-FLEX 4).
PROCEDURE
+ 161 + + 0(Off) +
Reference
1. Attendant Override : 2.13.5
Description
If this value is set to ON, privacy warning tone will be heard when the call is overridden.
PROCEDURE
+ 161 + + 0(Off) +
Reference
1. Attendant Override : 2.13.5
278
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 161 + + 1(Yes) +
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 161 + + 1(On) +
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 161 + + 1(On) +
Reference
1. ACD (Automatic Call Distribution) : 2.6.7
Description
279
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
+ 161 + + 002 +
(RANGE: 001~225)
Reference
1. ACD (Automatic Call Distribution) : 2.6.7
Description
If this value is set to ON, ACD database is initialized after printed out.
PROCEDURE
+ 161 + + 1(On) +
Reference
1. ACD (Automatic Call Distribution) : 2.6.7
Description
This value is gain of VMIB Announcement(Prompt). Whenever VMIB Announcement is played, this
value is applied.
Value : 00 ~ 31
PROCEDURE
+ 161 + + 00 +
(Range:00 - 31)
Description
280
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
If this value is set to ON, CLI is added when Voice Mail information is printed through RS232 port by
SMDI.
PROCEDURE
+ 161 + + 1(On) +
Description
This value determines the unit of ACD Print timer(ADMIN 161 - FLEX 10).
(1 hour or 10 seconds)
PROCEDURE
+ 161 + + 1(Hour) +
Reference
1. ACD (Automatic Call Distribution) : 2.6.7
Description
PROCEDURE
To change the value, user can do as follows.
+ 161 + + 1(Type ) +
Description
281
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
If this value is set to ON, the system checks toll of incoming CO call.
Value : ON =1 / OFF=0
PROCEDURE
+ 161 + + 1(On) +
Description
If Auto FAX CO line is programmed, the system answers and detects FAX calling tone(1100Hz,
0.5sec ON/3sec OFF repeat tone) from incoming analog CO line. The system route this call to last
SLT port on basic MBU(extension 17, extension 15 in compact type KSU) when tone is detected
within programmed time.
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to ENABLE, LED indication of {CO} button or {DSS} button is blocked.
(i.e. LED does not flash even if there is incoming call to the assigned CO Line or Station.)
This feature is not applied for direct call such as DID/DISA.
PROCEDURE
+ 161 + + 0(Disable) +
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 161 + + 1(On) +
Description
If this value is set to ON, the station’ COS is changed to 7 when station enters invalid authorization
code.
(If authorization code is assigned, station’ COS is down to 7 temporarily when station enters invalid
authorization code. Then station can recover his COS by COS RESTORE.
If not assigned, day & night COS in PGM 116 are changed to 7 when station enters invalid
authorization code. To recover COS, day & night COS should be reassigned.)
PROCEDURE
+ 161 + + 0(OFF) +
Reference
Description
If this value is set to ON, Authorization code is programmed as 5 digits fixed length. Under this mode,
5 digits of authorization code should be entered when related features are activated.
PROCEDURE
+ 161 + + 0(OFF) +
Related admin
Authorization Code Table(227)
283
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
ADMIN password can be assigned to enter ADMIN Programming mode for only Administrator who
knows the ADMIN password. It is not assigned by default.
PROCEDURE
To change the value, user can do as follows.
+ 162 + PASSWORD +
(4digits)
If you want to delete the ADMIN password, press the [speed] button.
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 163 + + 1(On) +
Reference
1. Alarm 2.4.2
Description
284
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
+ 163 + + 0(Open) +
Reference
1. Alarm 2.4.2
Description
PROCEDURE
To change the value, user can do as follows.
Reference
1. Alarm 2.4.2
Description
If this value is set to REPEAT, the Alarm Signal is repeated until Alarm Reset.
PROCEDURE
+ 163 + + 0(Once) +
Reference
1. Alarm 2.4.2
285
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Maximum 5 Attendants can be assigned including the Main Attendants and System Attendant. The
system attendant is different from main attendant in aspect of the call handling and system
management priority. The system attendant has more powerful priority than main attendant. The
system and main attendants can be assigned to each 1 and maximum 4. So the sum of system and
main attendants should be less than 5. As default, the System Attendant is assigned to Station 101,
and others are not assigned.
Value : 1~5
Procedure
If you want to delete any system attendant, press the Flex. BTN, which want to delete and press the
[SPEED] button.
*Note: It is impossible to delete the first System Attendant.
User may set the number of the VMIB announcement for auto attendant.
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 165 + + 1(On) +
286
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Reference
1. VMIB Announcement for Auto Attendant : 2.11.5
Description
This value is the number of VMIB announcement played when Auto Attendant is activated.
Value : 00~70
PROCEDURE
+ 165 + + 01 +
Reference
1. VMIB Announcement for Auto Attendant : 2.11.5
When an external user of DID/DISA/TIE line tries to access another CO Line in the system, CO-to-
CO COS is applied. The attributes of CO-to-CO COS are the same as the station COS.
Reference
1. COS (Class Of Service) 2.5.4
Description
Value : 1~7
PROCEDURE
+ 166 + + 2 +
287
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Reference
1. Day/Night service 2.13.8
Description
Value : 1~7
PROCEDURE
+ 166 + + 2 +
Reference
1. Day/Night service 2.13.8
When there is a DID/DISA incoming call, if the destination is not answer / invalid / busy, the call is
routed to Attendant / Hunt group / or the caller gets the proper tone.
If Attendant is assigned for DID/DISA destination, first, the call will check ring assignment(ADMIN
144), if there exists ring assigned station the call is routed to that station. If there is not ring assigned
station, then the call is routed to Attendant.
If VMIB announcement usage is enabled, The proper announcement is presented to the caller before
the call is routed.
This destination is applied when DISA Retry Counter expired.
If the destination is set to attendant, system checks if there’s any ring assigned station and gives the
ring to assigned station first. If the ring assigned station does not answer also, then the attendant
receives the call.
Reference
1. DISA Retry Counter 4.4.1.4
2. Ring Assignment to Station 4.2.5.1
Description
When there is a DID/DISA incoming call, and if the caller dialed busy destination, the call is routed to
Busy Destination (Tone / Attendant / Hunt).
Value : FLEX1~FLEX3
- FLEX1: Tone
288
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
+ 167 + + FLEX2 +
(Range: FLEX1~3)
Description
When there is a DID/DISA incoming call, and if the caller dialed invalid number, the call is routed to
Error Destination (Tone / Attendant / Hunt).
Value : FLEX1~FLEX3
- FLEX1: Tone
- FLEX2: Attendant (Ring Assign)
- FLEX3: Forward to Hunt Group
PROCEDURE
To change the value, user can do as follows.
+ 167 + + FLEX2 +
(Range: FLEX1~3)
Description
When there is a DID/DISA incoming call, and the destination is not answer, the call is routed to No
Answer Destination (Tone / Attendant / Hunt).
PROCEDURE
+ 167 + + FLEX2 +
(Range: FLEX1~3)
Description
If the value is set to ON and VMIB is available, The proper VMIB announcement is presented to the
caller before the call is routed to each Destination.
289
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Reference
1. Voice Service : 2.11
Description
If the value is set to ON, Busy announcement is presented to the caller before the call is routed to
Busy Destination.
PROCEDURE
+ 167 + + + 0(On) +
(Range: FLEX1~5)
Description
If the value is set to ON, Error announcement is presented to the caller before the call is routed to
Error Destination.
PROCEDURE
+ 167 + + + 0(Off) +
(Range: FLEX1~5)
Description
If the value is set to ON, Busy announcement is presented to the caller before the call is routed to
Busy Destination when the original destination is in DND.
+ 167 + + + 0(Off) +
(Range: FLEX1~5)
Reference
1. DND(Do Not Disturb) : 2.4.9
Description
If the value is set to ON, No Answer announcement is presented to the caller before the call is routed
to No Answer Destination.
PROCEDURE
+ 167 + + + 0(Off) +
(Range: FLEX1~5)
Description
If the value is set to ON, Attendant Transfer announcement is presented to the caller before the call
is routed to Attendant.
PROCEDURE
+ 167 + + + 0(Off) +
(Range: FLEX1~5)
Description
When DID/DISA call is rerouted by no answer forward/CCR and if rereouted destination is busy case,
calls follows by reroute busy destation(PGM 167-Flexible button 5)
Value : FLEX1~FLEX3
- FLEX1: Tone
- FLEX2: Attendant (Ring Assign)
291
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
+ 167 + + +
(Range: FLEX1~3)
Description
When DID/DISA call is rerouted by no answer forward/CCR and if rereouted destination is error case,
calls follows by reroute error destation(PGM 167-Flexible button 6)
Value : FLEX1~FLEX3
- FLEX1: Tone
- FLEX2: Attendant (Ring Assign)
- FLEX3: Forward to Hunt Group
PROCEDURE
To change the value, user can do as follows.
+ 167 + + +
(Range: FLEX1~3)
Description
If No Answer Destination is too busy, the call is rerouted to Reroute No ANS Destination (Tone /
Attendant / Hunt).
PROCEDURE
+ 167 + + +
(Range: FLEX1~3)
292
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If an External Control Contact is assigned to LBC, then it is activated when the station is ringing.
Then the ringing call of the station is notified loudly. In the night mode, LBC1 may be programmed to
provide external night ringing. In this case LBC1 does not follow its associated station’s ring.
Value : 1~3
1: LBC (STA #)
2: Door
3: Ext. 1
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. UNA (UNIVERSAL NIGHT ANSWER) : 2.1.7
Description
Value : 1~3
- 1: LBC (STA #)
- 2: Door
- 3: Ext. 1
PROCEDURE
+ 168 + + 2 +
(Range: FLEX1~2)
293
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
Value: 1~3
- 1: LBC (STA #)
- 2: Door
- 3: Ext. 1
PROCEDURE
+ 168 + + 3 +
(Range: FLEX1~2)
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 169 + + 0(24H) +
Description
Two LCD date formats are Day/Month/Year (DDMMYY) or Month/Day/Year (MMDDYY) mode.
PROCEDURE
+ 169 + + 1(MMDDYY) +
294
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
Value : 00~14
- 00: English
- 01: Italian
- 02: Finnish
- 03: Dutch
- 04: Swedish
- 05: Danish
- 06: Norwegian
- 07: Hebrew
- 08: Germany
- 09: French
- 10: Portuguese
- 11: Spanish
- 12: Korean
- 13: Estonia
- 14: Russian
PROCEDURE
To change the value, user can do as follows.
+ 169 + + Value +
(Range: 00~14)
Description
This value means the Modem-associated station. To use Modem line flexibly, associate one station
with Modem. Then incoming CO Call is connected to Modem device if the station gets the call.
The last station is assigned as Modem associated station.
Value :
- 10~37
Default value :
- 37
PROCEDURE
295
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
4.4.11.2 CO No.
Description
If CO Line is associated with Modem, All of the incoming CO Call through this Line is connected to
Modem. The Modem-associated CO Line cannot be used to outgoing CO Call.
Value :
- 01 ~ 08
PROCEDURE
+ 170 + + CO Number +
Description
Value : 0~8
0: Not Assignment
1: Int. Music
2: External Music
3: VMIB BGM
4 -8: SLT MOH
PROCEDURE
+ 171 + + Value +
(BGM Type)
Description
When a CO line call is placed in the hold state (system, exclusive, transfer, conference, etc) the
external party will hear music. In this way, the CO line party can be notified that the connection is still
established.
Value : 0~9
0: Not Assignment
1: Int. Music
2: External Music
3: VMIB BGM
4 – 8: SLT MOH
9: Hold Tone
296
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
+ 171 + + Value +
(MOH Type)
Reference
1. MOH (Music On Hold) : 2.4.17
Description
Value : 0~9
0: No BGM
1: Int. Music
2: External Music
3: VMIB BGM
4 – 8: SLT MOH
PROCEDURE
+ 171 + + Value +
(Music Channel)
Reference
1. ICM Box Music Selection 2.13.10
Description
To assign SLT MOH, set this value and match the SLT station number of the SLT port.
PROCEDURE
297
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Reference
1. SLT MOH : 2.4.17.1
Description
To assign external dial tone, set the SLT station number of the SLT port.
PROCEDURE
Description
To assign external ICM ring back tone, set the SLT station number of the SLT port.
PROCEDURE
Maximum 4 PABX Access Codes can be assigned. Each PABX Access Code is 1 or 2-digit number.
298
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
Value : 1 or 2 digits
PROCEDURE
The PLA Priority among Transferred Call, Recalled Call, Incoming Call, Queued Call can be set.
Description
VALUE : 1~4
PROCEDURE
+ 173 + + 4 + + 3 + + 2
+ + 1 +
Reference
1. PLA (Preferred Line Answer) : 2.1.2
299
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
Baud Rate, CTS/RTS, P-Break, LPP can be assigned at this feature to COM1 port, COM2 – MODU
port.
Value : FLEX1~FLEX4
FLEX ITEM VALUE DEFAULT REMARK
0: N/A 1: N/A
2: 1200 Baud 3: 2400 Baud
1 BAUDRATE 0-7(Note1) 19200
4: 4800 Baud 5: 9600 Baud
6: 19200 Baud 7: 38400 Baud
2 CTS/RTS ON/OFF OFF
3 P-BREAK ON/OFF OFF
4 LPP 001-199 060
PROCEDURE
COM 1
+ 173 + + + 7(38400) +
(Baudrate)
+ 173 + + + 7(38400) +
(Baudrate)
300
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
Value :
- 01~11
PROCEDURE
+ 175 + + Value +
Reference
1. SMDR : 2.12
Description
When ADMIN 451 is used, the ADMIN data is printed through this port.
Value :
- 01~11
PROCEDURE
+ 175 + + Value +
301
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
4.4.16.3 Traffic
Description
Value :
- 01~11
PROCEDURE
+ 175 + + Value +
Reference
1. Traffic Analysis : 2.18
Description
Value :
- 01~11
PROCEDURE
+ 175 + + Value +
Description
Value :
- 01~11
PROCEDURE
+ 175 + + Value +
302
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
Value :
- 01~11
PROCEDURE
+ 175 + + Value +
Reference
1. SMDR : 2.12
4.4.16.7 Trace
Description
Value :
- 01~11
PROCEDURE
+ 175 + + Value +
Reference
1. SMDR : 2.12
4.4.16.8 Debug
Description
Value :
- 01~11
PROCEDURE
+ 175 + + Value +
Reference
1. SMDR : 2.12
303
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
4.4.16.9 PC ADMIN
Description
Value :
- 01~11
PROCEDURE
+ 175 + + Value +
Reference
PC ADMIN programming manual
4.4.16.10 PC Attendant
Description
Value :
- 01~11
PROCEDURE
+ 175 + + Value +
Reference
PC ADMIN programming manual
4.4.16.11 CTI
Description
Value
- 01~11
PROCEDURE
+ 175 + + Value +
304
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
Value
- 01~11
PROCEDURE
+ 175 + + Value +
Description
Value : 1 / 0
- 2 : 10 PPS 50/50% (Not available in IP LDK-20)
- 1 : 10 PPS 66/33%
- 0 : 10 PPS 60/40%
PROCEDURE
+ 176 + 0(60/40%) +
Station Message Detail Recording (SMDR) will provide details on both incoming and outgoing calls.
As an assignable database option, If All Call record type is selected, incoming and outgoing local and
long distance calls are all provided. If only Long Distance is selected, then only outgoing calls that
meet the toll check status requirements listed below are provided.
Description
If this value is set to ON, maximum 1000 of SMDR data can be recorded at system memory.
PROCEDURE
+ 177 + + 1(On) +
305
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If this value is set to ON, SDMR data can be printed real time through the serial/MODEM/LAN port.
PROCEDURE
+ 177 + + 1(On) +
4.4.18.3 Long Distance / All Call Recorded (SMDR Recording Call Type)
Description
If this value is set to LD, only long distance outgoing CO call is served SMDR.
If this value is set to ALL, all outgoing CO call is served SMDR.
The long distance call is defined that the call satisfy the condition of ADMIN program 177 – FLEX 4,
or ADMIN program 177 – FLEX 14.
PROCEDURE
+ 177 + + 0(Call) +
Description
The long distance call is defined that the call satisfy the condition of ADMIN program 177 – FLEX 4,
or ADMIN program 177 – FLEX 14.
If digit counters of the outgoing CO call are more than this value, it is considered as long distance
call.
Value : 07~15
PROCEDURE
+ 177 + + Value +
306
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 177 + + 1(On) +
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 177 + + 1(On) +
Description
Due to limited system memory size, in places where many calls take place, the SMDR record buffer
can easily saturated. So, if the customer doesn't need the detailed call information but total call, total
metering count and total cost for individual station, then it is possible to save only the total
accumulation, rather than the whole detailed records.
If this value is set to ON, not only total call, total metering count and total cost for individual station,
but also the detail call records are saved maximum 1000.
If this value is set to OFF, only total call, total metering count and total cost for individual station
information are served.
PROCEDURE
+ 177 + + 0(Off) +
307
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If this value is set non-zero value, the printed digits from right or left will be replace to ‘*’ symbol up to
this value.
The direction of right or left can be set at ADMIN program 177 – FLEX 13.
Value : 0~9
PROCEDURE
+ 177 + + Value +
Description
For easy identification of call cost, the currency unit can be entered with 3 alphabet characters to be
printed in front of call charge amount.
Value : 3 CHARACTERS
. – 13 A – 21 D – 31
Q – 11 B – 22 E – 32
Z – 12 C – 23 F – 33
1 – 10 2 – 20 3 – 30
G – 41 J – 51 M – 61
H – 42 K – 52 N – 62
I – 43 L – 53 O – 63
4 – 40 5 – 50 6 – 60
P – 71 W – 91
T – 81
R – 72 X – 92
U – 82
S – 73 Y – 93
V – 83
Q - 7½ Z – 9#
8 – 80
7 – 70 9 – 90
½1–Blank
½2 - : 0 – 00 #
½3 - ,
PROCEDURE
+ 177 + + 3 Characters +
308
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This is the call cost unit per cost metering pulse, which is sent from the Central Office.
Value : 6 digits(0~9)
PROCEDURE
+ 177 + + 001000 +
(Range: 6 digits)
Description
This value means the decimal position point of the cost per unit pulse
Value : 0~5
PROCEDURE
+ 177 + + Value +
Description
If this value is set non-zero value, only the outgoing CO call more than this value time is served
SDMR.
Value : 000~250
PROCEDURE
+ 177 + + Value(Timer) +
309
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If this value is set to RIGHT, SDMR digit hiding is executed the right-to-left direction.
At this case, if dialed ‘1234567890’, SDMR printed hidden digits are formatted ‘12345*****’.
If this value is set to LEFT, SDMR digit hiding is executed to left-to-right direction.
At this case, if dialed ‘1234567890’, SDMR printed hidden digits are formatted ‘*****67890’.
PROCEDURE
+ 177 + + 0(Left) +
Description
The long distance call is defined that the call satisfy the condition of ADMIN program 177 – FLEX 4,
or ADMIN program 177 – FLEX 14.
Max. 5 SMDR long distance codes are available. SMDR long distance code is 1 or 2 digit number. By
default, SMDR long distance code is 0.
Value : 1 or 2 Digits
Max. 5 SMDR long distance codes : FLEX1 ~ FLEX5
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to ON, the MSN number is printed instead of the station number when the
station made MSN outgoing call.
PROCEDURE
+ 177 + + I (enable) +
Reference
310
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
1. MSN (2.14.7)
Description
If this value is set to ON, the caller number is printed at incoming call SMDR.
PROCEDURE
+ 177 + + I (enable) +
Description
Value : 4 digits
PROCEDURE
Description
Value : 6 digits
PROCEDURE
+ 178 + + Value +
(MMDDYY
311
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
Value : 100~399
- FLEX 1: VIEW
- FLEX 2: INPUT
PROCEDURE
Review Linked Station Pairs
312
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 185 + + 1(On) +
Description
Analog CO line CLI carries the caller’s telephone number and name.
According to this ADMIN program value, LCD displayed data can be selected.
If this value is set to NAME, the caller’s name will be displayed on LCD.
If this value is set to TELEPHONE NUMBER, the caller’s telephone number will be displayed on LCD.
PROCEDURE
+ 185 + + 1(Name) +
Description
This ADMIN program set the port connected to CIDU hardware device.
* Note: This ADMIN program is only needed, when the external CIDU hardware device is installed.
Value :
1
313
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
Description
When external CID equipment is used, this program set CID port and the analog CO line port
mapping. This is no need when LCOB with optional CID detection board is used.
Value : 00~11
PROCEDURE
+ 185 + + + CO Number +
Description
Value : None
PROCEDURE
+ 185 + +
Description
PROCEDURE
314
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
+ 185 + + 1 +
Description
If this value is set to ON, system provides a ring signal to SLT and CID will be displayed after 1st ringing.
(Caution ; if the CID SLT does not support non-standard CID, there can be a problem displaying correct CID.)
PROCEDURE
+ 185 + + 0 +
Description
If a recalled call arrives to a attendant, the attendant may not answer the call. Then the system
disconnect the call if the attendant don’t answer the call for some time. This ADMIN program set the
amount of time before system disconnects the call
PROCEDURE
+ 180 + + Value(min) +
Description
Setting the amount of time before a call placed in a call park location will recall the station placing the
park
PROCEDURE
315
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
+ 180 + + Value(sec) +
Description
When a station transfers to busy station by Camp-On, if the transferred-to station don’t answer the
call, the call will recall to transferring station after setting time passes. Therefore This ADMIN
program set the appropriate time.
PROCEDURE
+ 180 + + Value(sec) +
Description
Select the amount of time before a call placed on system hold will recall the station placing the hold.
PROCEDURE
+ 180 + + Value(sec) +
Description
When recalled call don’t answer, the call will recall to attendant after setting time passes. Therefore
This ADMIN program set the appropriate time.
Select the amount of time before a call recalls the attendant
PROCEDURE
+ 180 + + Value(sec) +
316
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
Determines the amount of time before a call placed on system hold will recall the station placing the
hold.
PROCEDURE
+ 180 + + Value(sec) +
Description
Select the amount of time a transferred call will ring at the station receiving the transfer and how long
it will recall the station transferring the call.
PROCEDURE
+ 180 + + Value(sec) +
Description
When ACNR Pause Timer expires and there is no available CO Line in the group, ACNR trial is
delayed for this timer .
PROCEDURE
+ 180 + + Value(sec) +
317
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This timer is invoked after system detects CO ring back tone from CO party. If the call isn’t answered,
system disconnect the call. And wait next ACNR trial.
PROCEDURE
+ 180 + + Value(sec) +
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 180 + + Value(sec) +
Description
ACNR is executed up to this value. After trial of this retry counter, ACNR is canceled.
PROCEDURE
Description
This ADMIN program can set the trial number of seizing the CO line for ACNR. If the CO line isn’t
seized, ACNR will be canceled.
318
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
Description
This timer is invoked upon completion of dialing and system considers the CO party is busy when the
CPTU cannot detect the valid tone type until this timer expires.
PROCEDURE
+ 180 + + Value(sec) +
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 180 + + Value(sec) +
Description
This timer is used for the CCR inter-digit timer in the DISA/DID CO line. In DID type 2, it is used for
DID inter-digit timer.
PROCEDURE
319
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
+ 180 + + Value(msec) +
Description
If prepaid money is going to expire during a CO call, system will give warning tone, and after this
time, the call will be disconnected. This timer is also used for call drop warning in Unsupervised
Conference.
PROCEDURE
+ 180 + + Value(sec) +
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 180 + + Value(min) +
Description
Voice connection to the outside party will be made after this timer. This can be used to prevent illegal
dialing in case of slow response from the Central Office Line or PBX.
PROCEDURE
320
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
+ 180 + + Value(100msec) +
Description
This ADMIN program sets the amount of time before a CO line can be re-seized, after the CO call
disconnects.
This timer controls the time necessary to guarantee idle loop state when the analog CO line is
released.
PROCEDURE
+ 180 + + Value(100msec) +
Description
This timer is to secure time interval between incoming ringing signals so that the active ringing can
be lasted in the system until this timer is expired.
PROCEDURE
+ 180 + + Value(100msec) +
Description
This timer controls the time necessary to detect an incoming CO call as ringing into the system.
PROCEDURE
+ 180 + + Value(100msec) +
321
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
Determines the amount of time before receiving warning tone in order to remind the call elapsed time
in case of outgoing CO line conversation (Only for Korea).
PROCEDURE
+ 180 + + Value(sec) +
Description
This timer is used at the no answer call forward feature(Section 2.3.1.2, and 2.3.1.3). If station is set
the no answer call forward type, and if station don’t answer during this timer, then the call will be
routed to the forward destination.
PROCEDURE
+ 181 + + Value(sec) +
Description
This timer is used at DID or DISA call routing. If station doesn’t answer about DID/DISA call during
this timer, the call will be routed to ADMIN program 167 – FLEX 3 value.
PROCEDURE
+ 181 + + Value(sec) +
322
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This is the maximum time that station user can record his VMIB announcement.
PROCEDURE
+ 181 + + Value(sec) +
Description
This is the minimum time that station user must record his VMIB announcement.
If this value is set to 0, VMIB announcement can not be recorded.
PROCEDURE
+ 181 + + Value(sec) +
Description
Select the length of time that is needed to execute the door open relay for the setting time.
PROCEDURE
+ 181 + + Value(100msec) +
323
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
Select the ringing time of the ICM box associated stations, when ICM box user press [CALL] button.
PROCEDURE
+ 181 + + Value(sec) +
Description
This timer is used when the off-hooked station is heard the intercom dial tone. If station doesn’t dial a
digit within this timer, error tone is provided.
PROCEDURE
+ 181 + + Value(sec) +
Description
This timer is used when station is dialing some digits. The time between digits cannot exceed Inter-
digit timer, or error tone is provided.
PROCEDURE
+ 181 + + Value(sec) +
324
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
Select the amount of time between repeated reminder tones to station that it has a message waiting.
PROCEDURE
+ 181 + + Value(sec) +
Description
Select the maximum time of a page. The system will automatically disconnect the page at the end of
this time unless the caller has hung up earlier.
PROCEDURE
+ 181 + + Value(sec) +
Description
This timer is used at the speed dialing feature, LNR, and etc. In case of the speed dial or LNR, LDK
system sends the dial digits to the outgoing analog CO line, after this time.
PROCEDURE
+ 181 + + Value(sec) +
Description
325
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
This timer is used at the preset call forward feature(Section 2.3.1.9). After this timer expires,
incoming call will be forwarded to a predetermined station.
PROCEDURE
+ 181 + + Value(sec) +
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 181 + + Value(sec) +
Description
This timer is used only in 3soft BTN DKTU(LDH-30DH). In 3soft menu, if there is no any digit within
time, the DKTU turn to Idle state.
PROCEDURE
+ 181 + + Value(sec) +
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 181 + + Value(100msec) +
326
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
Master sends the connect message to slave system after this timer when the transit out
CO type is a pulse analog trunk.
PROCEDURE
+ 181 + + Value(sec) +
Description
If the user press [REWIND] button while listening left VMIB message, the message is
rewound as this timer.
PROCEDURE
+ 181 + + Value(sec) +
Description
This timer is used at SLT only. Select the length of time that is needed to regard as a valid on-hook or
off-hook (for SLT).
PROCEDURE
+ 182 + + Value(100msec) +
327
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This timer is used at SLT only. Select how long the user could press the hook switch in order for it to
be considered a FLASH (Timed-Break Recall) (for SLT).
PROCEDURE
+ 182 + + Value(10msec) +
Description
This timer is used at SLT only. The minimum bound time that system considers as hook flash for SLT.
PROCEDURE
+ 182 + + Value(10msec) +
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 182 + + Value(sec) +
Description
328
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
If a station hears ring back tone and no action is taken, this timer is assigned. When this timer is
expired, the station is released.
PROCEDURE
+ 182 + + Value(10msec) +
Description
Select the amount of the time that an unsupervised conference can continue after the initiator of the
conference has exited the conference.
PROCEDURE
+ 182 + + Value(min) +
Description
After a Wake-up fail ring invokes on system attendant, the alarm ring exists during this timer. If this
timer expires, the alarm ring will be disappeared.
PROCEDURE
+ 182 + + Value(sec) +
Description
329
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
User takes no action after lifting handset or pressing the [MON] button and this timer is expired, then
idle line selection for warm line is executed.
PROCEDURE
+ 182 + + Value(sec) +
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 182 + + Value(10msec) +
Description
This timer is used at the enblock dialing sending feature. If station user make a call at the enblock
dialing mode, and if station user doesn’t dial within this time, then the enblock dialing is executed.
PROCEDURE
+ 182 + + Value(sec) +
Description
330
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
+ 182 + + Value(sec) +
Description
This timer is used at DID type 2 feature. In DID type2, LDK system will be wait the new DID digit
receiving until this timer is expired. If this timer is expired, the call routing of DID type 2 is executed.
PROCEDURE
+ 182 + + Value(sec) +
Description
This timer is used to detect FAX tone from FAX CO line. During this timer, LDK system will be wait to
detect FAX tone. If this timer is expired, the call is routed to the ring assigned stations for FAX CO
line. Considering FAX calling tone cadence(0.5sec ON/3sec OFF repeated), 5 sec is proper for FAX
tone detect timer.
PROCEDURE
+ 182 + + Value(sec) +
Description
When FAX tone is detected from FAX CO line, this call is routed to the FAX station. And if this call is
not answered during this timer, this call will be dropped.
331
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
+ 182 + + Value(sec) +
Description
Value : 0~7
- 0: Not Assigned
- 1: Circular
- 2: Terminal
- 3: UCD
- 4: Ring
- 5: VM
- 6: Pick up
- 7: Net VM
PROCEDURE
Description
332
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Except pick-up hunt group, all type of hunt group can be assigned the pick-up attribute optionally.
PROCEDURE
Description
Value :
- 100~125
PROCEDURE
If the hunt group type is selected at ADMIN program 190, then the attributes of each hunt group can
be programmed at ADMIN program 191.
Description
If the hunt group type is selected to CIRCULAR or TERMINAL(Section 2.6.2, 2.6.3), then the
following attributes for CIRCULAR or TERMINAL hunt group can be programmed at ADMIN program
191.
Description
333
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
If the call doesn’t answered during this timer, the system plays VMIB announcement that is
programmed at ADMIN program 191 – FLEX 3.
Value : 000~999
PROCEDURE
Description
The second VMIB announcement can be played if the call continues to wait beyond the 2nd
announcement timer. The played VMIB announcement can be programmed at ADMIN program 191
– FLEX 4.
Value : 000~999
PROCEDURE
Description
This is used to play VMIB announcement, when the VMIB announce 1 timer is expired.
PROCEDURE
Description
This is used to play VMIB announcement, when the VMIB announce 2 timers is expired.
This second VMIB announcement can be played repeat, according to ADMIN program 191 – FLEX 5
and 6 value.
334
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
Description
This is used to repeat VMIB announce 2 when the timer is expired. (000: Not assigned).
Value : 000~999
PROCEDURE
Description
PROCEDURE
Description
The call to a station in the group will continue to route until answered or each station in the group has
been tried. The call will remain at the last station in the group or will be passed to this overflow
station/group/ VMIB/System Speed bin, after overflow timer expiring. The overflow timer can be set at
ADMIN program 191 – FLEX 8.
335
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
Description
If this timer expires after a call is received in the group, the call is routed to the overflow destination.
The overflow destination can be set at ADMIN program 191 – FLEX 7.
Value : 000~600
PROCEDURE
Description
A station in a hunt group is maintained in a busy state during this timer value, after the end of
received call and outgoing call for the assigned wrap-up time.
Value : 002~999
PROCEDURE
Description
In circular/terminal hunt, if the incoming call is not answered during this time, the call is routed to the
next idle station in the group.
Value : 00~99
336
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set ON, the call to the each hunt group member is processed as the call to hunt group.
A circular/terminal hunt group can be assigned with a pilot number (the station group) so that only
calls to the pilot number will hunt.
PROCEDURE
Description
If there is no member on duty, intercom call will be dropped and CO incoming call will be routed to
overflow destination, or to ring assigned station if overflow destination is not assigned.
PROCEDURE
337
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If music source is assigned, calling user will be heard music instead of ring back tone.
Value : 0~8
PROCEDURE
- 0: Not assigned by this field.
+ 191 + Hunt Group NUMBER +
- 1: Internal Music + Value(Music Source) +
- 2: External Music
- 3: VMIB MOH
- 4 – 8: SLT MOH
Description
If there is no member on duty or all member is busy, CO incoming call will be routed to alternative
destination.
PROCEDURE
Description
If there is no member on duty or all member is busy, CO incoming call will be queuing. Than Hunt
Group Supervisor can see the queued incoming call count until max queue count.
PROCEDURE
338
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If the call doesn’t answered during this timer, the system plays VMIB announcement that is
programmed at ADMIN program 191 – FLEX 3.
Value : 000~999
PROCEDURE
Description
The second VMIB announcement can be played if the call continues to wait beyond the 2nd
announcement timer. The played VMIB announcement can be programmed at ADMIN program 191
– FLEX 4.
Value : 000~999
PROCEDURE
Description
This is used to play VMIB announcement, when the VMIB announce 1 timer is expired.
PROCEDURE
339
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This is used to play VMIB announcement, when the VMIB announce 2 timers is expired.
This second VMIB announcement can be played repeat, according to ADMIN program 191 – FLEX 5
and 6 value.
PROCEDURE
Description
This is used to repeat VMIB announce 2 when the timer is expired. (000: Not repeat).
Value : 000~999
PROCEDURE
Description
PROCEDURE
340
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
The call to a station in the group will continue to route until answered or each station in the group has
been tried. The call will remain at the last station in the group or will be passed to this overflow
station/group/ VMIB/System Speed bin, after overflow timer expiring. The overflow timer can be set at
ADMIN program 191 – FLEX 8.
PROCEDURE
Description
If this timer expires after a call is received in the group, the call is routed to the overflow destination.
The overflow destination can be set at ADMIN program 191 – FLEX 7.
Value : 000~600
PROCEDURE
Description
A station in a hunt group is maintained in a busy state during this timer value, after the end of
received call and outgoing call for the assigned wrap-up time.
Value : 002~999
PROCEDURE
341
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If there is no member on duty, intercom call will be dropped and CO incoming call will be routed to
overflow destination, or to ring assigned station if overflow destination is not assigned.
PROCEDURE
Description
If music source is assigned, calling user will be heard music instead of ring back tone.
Value : 0~8
- 0: Not assigned by this field.
- 1: Internal Music
- 2: External Music
- 3: VMIB MOH
- 4 - 8: SLT MOH
PROCEDURE
Description
When a call is received in the group and there is no available station in the group, then the call will be
routed to this destination if assigned.
PROCEDURE
342
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
When a call is received in the group and there is no available station in the group, then the call will be
routed to this destination if assigned. But it must be avoided to program the alternate destination as
the hunt group itself. For example, the alternate destination of group 620 should not be group 620.
PROCEDURE
Description
If there is no idle member at hunt group, the incoming call will be queued.
If the total queued call count is more than the supervisor call count value, and ACD queued call
ADMIN program value is set to ON, and the queued time is longer than this timer, then the counts of
queued calls will be displayed onto supervisor's LCD.
The supervisor call count can be programmed at ADMIN program 191 – FLEX 15.
The ACD queued call can be programmed at ADMIN program 191 – FLEX 16.
Value : 000~999
PROCEDURE
Description
If the number of queued calls is more than this call count, the supervisor timer will be started.
The supervisor timer can be programmed at ADMIN program 191 – FLEX 14.
Value : 00~99
PROCEDURE
343
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If this value is set to ON, the count of queued call can be displayed on supervisor station LCD.
PROCEDURE
Description
This value is the maximum call count that can be queued.
If the total queued call count is this value, the next queuing tried call will be disconnected.
Value : 00~99
PROCEDURE
4.7.2.2.18 Supervisor
Description
PROCEDURE
344
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
PROCEDURE
If the hunt group type is selected to RING(Section 2.6.4), then the following attributes for RING hunt
group can be programmed at ADMIN program 191.
Description
If the call doesn’t answered during this timer, the system plays VMIB announcement that is
programmed at ADMIN program 191 – FLEX 3.
Value : 000~999
PROCEDURE
Description
The second VMIB announcement can be played if the call continues to wait beyond the 2nd
announcement timer. The played VMIB announcement can be programmed at ADMIN program 191
– FLEX 4.
Value : 000~999
PROCEDURE
345
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This is used to play VMIB announcement, when the VMIB announce 1 timer is expired.
PROCEDURE
Description
This is used to play VMIB announcement, when the VMIB announce 2 timers is expired.
This second VMIB announcement can be played repeat, according to ADMIN program 191 – FLEX 5
and 6 value.
PROCEDURE
Description
This is used to repeat VMIB announce 2 when the timer is expired. (000: Not repeat).
Value : 000~999
PROCEDURE
346
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
PROCEDURE
Description
The call to a station in the group will continue to route until answered or each station in the group has
been tried. The call will remain at the last station in the group or will be passed to this overflow
station/group/ VMIB/System Speed bin, after overflow timer expiring. The overflow timer can be set at
ADMIN program 191 – FLEX 8.
PROCEDURE
Description
If this timer expires after a call is received in the group, the call is routed to the overflow destination.
The overflow destination can be set at ADMIN program 191 – FLEX 7.
Value : 000~600
PROCEDURE
347
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
A station in a hunt group is maintained in a busy state during this timer value, after the end of
received call and outgoing call for the assigned wrap-up time.
Value : 002~999
PROCEDURE
Description
If music source is assigned, calling user will be heard music instead of ring back tone.
Value : 0~8
PROCEDURE
Description
Value : 00~99
PROCEDURE
348
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
Value : STA #
- 100~125
PROCEDURE
If the hunt group type is selected to VM(Ref Section 2.6.5), then the following attributes for VM hunt
group can be programmed at ADMIN program 191.
Description
A station in a hunt group is maintained in a busy state during this timer value, after the end of received
call and outgoing call for the assigned wrap-up time.
Value : 002~999
PROCEDURE
Description
Value : 1~4
PROCEDURE
349
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
Value : 1~4
PROCEDURE
Description
PROCEDURE
Description
Value : 01~11
350
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
Description
If this timer expires after a call is received in the group, the call is routed to the overflow destination.
The overflow destination can be set at ADMIN program 191 – FLEX 7.
Value : 000~600
PROCEDURE
Description
The call to a station in the group will continue to route until answered or each station in the group has
been tried. The call will remain at the last station in the group or will be passed to this overflow
station/group/ VMIB/System Speed bin, after overflow timer expiring. The overflow timer can be set at
ADMIN program 191 – FLEX 6.
PROCEDURE
If the hunt group type is selected to PICK-UP, then the following attributes for PICK-UP hunt group
can be programmed at ADMIN program 191.
351
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Reference
1. Group Call Pick Up 2.3.4.2
Description
If this value is set to ON, and if there is ringing hunt member, other hunt member can pickup the call
automatically only by pressing [MON] button or off-hook.
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to ON, and if a hunt group member receives an intercom call, then all hunt group
member is ringing. To set this value, ‘Auto Pickup’ ADMIN program value must be set to ON..
PROCEDURE
352
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
The AOC is the call cost information service that is provided by public ISDN.
According to the country, the standard of AOC type is different.
This value is used to set AOC type.
* Note: PGM 200 – FLEX 3 ~FLEX5, FLEX8: Reserved (Move to PGM 146)
Value : 0~6
- 0: Do not service AOC
- 1: Italy and Spain
- 2: Finland
- 3: Australia
- 4: Belgium
- 5: Standard
- 6: Netherlands
PROCEDURE
+ 200 + + Value +
Reference
1. AOC (Advice Of Charge) : 2.12.1
353
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This value is used when ISDN DID call incoming and outgoing case.
If the received DID digit is matched this value, then the call is routed to attendant station.
If ADMIN program 114 – FLEX 5 is set to CO ATD, and the station is make an outgoing CO call, then
this value is used as the outgoing station’s CLI data.
PROCEDURE
Description
This value is used to execute the CLI print about the incoming CO call.
If this value is set to ON, the CLI of the incoming CO call will be sent to serial/MODEM/LAN port.
PROCEDURE
+ 200 + + 1(On) +
Description
This value is used to modify the received CLI of the international incoming CO call.
If this value is set, and if station receives the international incoming CO call, then this value is
inserted in front of the CLI.
PROCEDURE
354
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
PROCEDURE
Description
This value is used to set the my area prefix code. (Normally zero value)
The combination of this value and ADMIN program 200 – FLEX 9 is compared with the received CLI,
and the received CO call can be judged the local call or the long distance call.
This value is also used the outgoing CLI data, when station makes an outgoing CO call.
PROCEDURE
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 200 + + 1(On) +
355
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This value is used the valid destination station about PC application connection request.
Value : STA #
- 10~35
PROCEDURE
Description
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. CLI(Calling Line Identification Presentation) 2.14.2
356
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Reference
1. MSN/Sub-Addressing : 2.14.7
Description
PROCEDURE
Description
If the received digit of Incoming CO call is matched MSN telephone number(ADMIN PGM 202 –
FLEX 4), it is MSN call.
This value is used to search the destination of MSN call routing.
This value indicates the entry index of flexible DID table(ADMIN program 231).
PROCEDURE
357
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This value is only used when the destination station type is ISDN telephone.
If the destination is ISDN telephone, this value is sent as the ISDN sub-address number of it.
PROCEDURE
Description
PROCEDURE
Description
This value controls the type of ISDN Terminal Equipment Identification of each BRI port.
PROCEDURE
+ 203 + + + (Toggle) +
(Range: FLEX1~FLEX4)
358
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This sets the service type for ISDN Hold/Retrieve Supplementary services.
PROCEDURE
+ 203 + + value +
Description
This determines the code for ISDN Supplementary Hold.
PROCEDURE
+ 203 + + value(Max:10digits) +
Description
This determines the code for ISDN Supplementary Retrieve.
PROCEDURE
+ 203 + + value(Max:10digits) +
Description
This sets B channel selection Type.
PROCEDURE
+ 203 + + value +
359
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This determines the code for Barring up code .
PROCEDURE
+ 203 + + value(Max:10digits) +
Description
This determines the code for Barring down code .
PROCEDURE
+ 203 + + value(Max:10digits) +
Description
This determines the code for CFU Activation Code .
PROCEDURE
+ 203 + + value(Max:10digits) +
Description
This determines the code for CFU Deactivation Code .
PROCEDURE
+ 203 + + value(Max:10digits) +
360
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This determines the code for Memo-Tel Activation Code .
PROCEDURE
+ 203 + + value(Max:10digits) +
Description
This determines the code for Memo-Tel Timer Code.
PROCEDURE
+ 203 + + value(Max:10digits) +
Description
This determines the code for Memo-Tel Activation LNR Code .
PROCEDURE
+ 203 + + value(Max:10digits) +
Description
This determines the code for Memo-Tel Interrogation Code .
PROCEDURE
+ 203 + + value(Max:10digits) +
361
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This determines the code for Memo-Tel Retrieve MSRS(Message Retrieve System) Code .
PROCEDURE
+ 203 + + value(Max:10digits) +
Description
This determines the code for Memo-Tel Deactivation Code.
PROCEDURE
+ 203 + + value(Max:10digits) +
362
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
4.9 LCR
To enter LCR ADMIN program, press the [TRANS/PGM] button and dial LCR ADMIN program
number. The LCR ADMIN program number range is 220-223. There are 4 parts in the LCR table.
User can program general database, LCR access mode, day zone and time zone by PGM 220. PGM
221 is for Leading Digit Table and PGM 222 is for Digit Modification Table. PGM 223 may initialize
the stored database for LCR.
The example of LCR is illustrated at ‘Section 2.7’.
363
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 220 + + Value +
Description
PROCEDURE
364
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
*Note: LDK accepts it as the same value for 00 and 24 and changes to “00”, if input is 24 as starting
value and vice versa.
*Note: The time not belonging to any zone will be considered as zone 1
*Note: 10 - 13 means 10:00:00(AM) - 01:00:00(PM)
PROCEDURE
+ 220 + + + Value2 +
(Value: Time Zone1)
Description
*Note: LDK accepts it as the same value for 00 and 24 and changes to “00”, if input is 24 as starting
value and vice versa.
*Note: The time not belonging to any zone will be considered as zone 1
*Note: 10 - 13 means 10:00:00(AM) - 01:00:00(PM)
PROCEDURE
+ 220 + + + Value2 +
(Value: Time Zone2)
365
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
*Note: LDK accepts it as the same value for 00 and 24 and changes to “00”, if input is 24 as starting
value and vice versa.
*Note: The time not belonging to any zone will be considered as zone 1
*Note: 10 - 13 means 10:00:00(AM) - 01:00:00(PM)
PROCEDURE
+ 220 + + + Value +
(Value: Time Zone3)
LDT(Leading Digit Table) is used to check whether digits that is dialed by user is LCR Code or not.
If digits that is dialed by user are equal to LCR Code(ADMIN program 221 – FLEX 2), the digits is
converted and CO line is seized according to DMT(ADMIN program 222).
In LDK system, maximum 250 LDT entry can be programmed. Each LDT entry has six sub-attributes,
‘LCR type’, ‘LCR code’, ‘DMT index for day zone 1/2/3’, and ‘Check password’.
366
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
PROCEDURE
Description
If digits that is dialed by user are equal to this value, the digits is converted and CO line is seized
according to DMT(ADMIN program 222).
PROCEDURE
Description
This value is used to set the table index DMT(ADMIN program 222) of the day zone 1.
Because day zone 1 has 3 different time zone, three table index of each time must be selected.
The example of this ADMIN programming is illustrated at ‘Section 2.7’.
PROCEDURE
367
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This value is used to set the table index DMT(ADMIN program 222) of the day zone 2.
Because day zone 2 has 3 different time zone, three table index of each time must be selected.
The example of this ADMIN programming is illustrated at ‘Section 2.7’.
PROCEDURE
Description
This value is used to set the table index DMT(ADMIN program 222) of the day zone 2.
Because day zone 2 has 3 different time zone, three table index of each time must be selected.
The example of this ADMIN programming is illustrated at ‘Section 2.7’.
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set to ON, LDK system request the account code of user, when dialed digit is matched
LCR code.
368
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
DMT(Digit Modification Table) is used to convert the dialed digit and seize the outgoing CO line.
In LDK system, maximum 100 DMT entry can be programmed. Each DMT entry has six sub-
attributes, ‘Added digit stream’, ‘Removal position’, ‘Remove Number’, ‘Add position’, ‘CO Line
Group’, and ‘Alternative DMT index’.
Description
This value is used to add some digit stream at user dialed digits.
This value is added at the position of ‘Add Position’(ADMIN program 222 – FLEX 4).
The example of this ADMIN programming is illustrated at ‘Section 2.7’.
*Note: The programmable normal digits and special characters are below:
z Normal digits (0 .. 9, * , #)
z Special characters
- [CALLBK]: Pause
- [DND/FOR]: Dial-tone-detection instead of pause Enter
- [FLASH]: Billing code (Station Number)
PROCEDURE
369
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This value is used to set the removal position at user dialed digits.
Some digits are removed from the this position up to ‘Remove Number’ (ADMIN program 222 –
FLEX 3).
The example of this ADMIN programming is illustrated at ‘Section 2.7’.
PROCEDURE
Description
This value is used to set the remove digit count at user dialed digits.
Some digits are removed as much as this value from the position of ‘Removal Position’ (ADMIN
program 222 – FLEX 2).
The example of this ADMIN programming is illustrated at ‘Section 2.7’.
PROCEDURE
Description
This value is used to set the add position at user dialed digits.
Some digits are added from the this position with ‘Add Digit Stream’ (ADMIN program 222 – FLEX 1).
The example of this ADMIN programming is illustrated at ‘Section 2.7’.
PROCEDURE
370
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This value is used when LCR call seize the outgoing CO line.
The idle CO line within CO Line Group of this value is seized for LCR call.
The example of this ADMIN programming is illustrated at ‘Section 2.7’.
PROCEDURE
Description
This value is used when LCR call can’t seize the idle CO line within ADMIN program 222 – FLEX 5.
If LCR call can’t seize the idle CO line within LCR CO Line Group, LCR call seize the idle CO within
CO Line Group of this value DMT index.
PROCEDURE
371
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This ADMIN program change the index of DMT value of day zone 1 to new value.
PROCEDURE
Description
This ADMIN program change the index of DMT value of day zone 2 to new value.
PROCEDURE
Description
This ADMIN program change the index of DMT value of day zone 3 to new value.
PROCEDURE
372
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This ADMIN program change the all CO Line Group values of DMT entry to new value.
PROCEDURE
Description
This ADMIN program change the all ‘Alternative DMT Index’ values of DMT entry to new value.
Value: 00~99
PROCEDURE
Description
This ADMIN program initialize the all LCR ADMIN data to default value.
Value: None
PROCEDURE
+ 223 + +
373
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Reference
1. COS (Class Of Service) : 2.5.4
The Allow/Deny Tables are organized into 4 sets of tables to support 4 different toll plans at one
installed site. Each allow/deny table may contain up to 30 number strings. All bins of allow and deny
tables have no entries by default. Each number string can contain up to 14 entries including any
number 0-9, *, #, "Don't care".
The following rules should be remembered when setting up the Allow/Deny Tables:
(1) If the tables have no entries, no restriction is applied.
(2) If entries are made in the allow table and only there, then only those numbers are allowed.
(3) If entries are made in the deny table and only there, then only those numbers are denied.
(4) If there are entries in both tables, the allow table is searched at first and if number is found, it is
allowed. If not found, the deny table is searched and if number is found, it is denied. If it is not
found in either table, it is allowed.
ENTRY CONDITIONS & RESULT
RULE
ALLOW DENY ALLOW TABLE DENY TABLE
1 Not Exist Not Exist No Restriction No Restriction
Found - allowed
2 Exist Not Exist -
Not found - denied
Found - denied
3 Not Exist Exist -
Not found - allowed
Found - allowed Found - denied
4 Exist Exist
Not found – check deny table Not Found - allowed
Description
This ADMIN value is used to check, whether the dialed digit by COS 2 and COS 4 station is matched
with the allowed toll pass digits or not.
Allow table A is only used when the COS of dialed station is COS 2 or 4.
PROCEDURE
374
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This ADMIN value is used to check, whether the dialed digit by COS 2 and COS 4 station is matched
with the denied toll pass digits or not.
Deny table A is only used when the COS of dialed station is COS 2 or 4.
PROCEDURE
Description
This ADMIN value is used to check, whether the dialed digit by COS 3 and COS 4 station is matched
with the allowed toll pass digits or not.
Allow table B is only used when the COS of dialed station is COS 3 or 4.
PROCEDURE
Description
This ADMIN value is used to check, whether the dialed digit by COS 3 and COS 4 station is matched
with the denied toll pass digits or not.
Deny table B is only used when the COS of dialed station is COS 3 or 4.
PROCEDURE
375
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This ADMIN value is used to check, whether the dialed digit by COS 8 station is matched with the
allowed toll pass digits or not.
Allow table A is only used when the COS of dialed station is COS 8.
PROCEDURE
Description
This ADMIN value is used to check, whether the dialed digit by COS 8 station is matched with the
denied toll pass digits or not.
Deny table A is only used when the COS of dialed station is COS 8.
PROCEDURE
Description
This ADMIN value is used to check, whether the dialed digit by COS 9 station is matched with the
allowed toll pass digits or not.
Allow table B is only used when the COS of dialed station is COS 9.
PROCEDURE
376
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This ADMIN value is used to check, whether the dialed digit by COS 9 station is matched with the
denied toll pass digits or not.
Deny table B is only used when the COS of dialed station is COS 9.
PROCEDURE
In addition to the basic toll restrictions, stations with a COS 5 or 6 are subject to dial restrictions
based on the “Canned” Allow and Deny Tables. This program permits entries in the Canned Toll
Tables. Both the Allow and Deny table have 20 bins up to 14 digits.
Description
This ADMIN value is used to check, whether the dialed digit by COS 5 and COS 6 station is matched
with the allowed toll pass digits or not.
Allow table of canned toll is only used when the COS of dialed station is COS 5 or 6.
PROCEDURE
377
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This ADMIN value is used to check, whether the dialed digit by COS 5 and COS 6 station is matched
with the denied toll pass digits or not.
Deny table of canned toll is only used when the COS of dialed station is COS 5 or 6.
PROCEDURE
The emergency code table is used for emergency call service. All stations, regardless of COS, can
dial the emergency codes in this table.
Description
PROCEDURE
378
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
4.11 TABLES
To program TABLES, press the [TRANS/PGM] button and dial 227 - 235.
Description
Authorization code table entries is consist of each station password and extra account codes. The
table entry from 001 to the maximum capacity of station numbers are saved the password of each
station. And the remains are the extra entries.
CO Line Groups can be marked to deny access until a matched Authorization code is entered. In this
case, DND warning tone is provided when the CO Line Group access code is dialed. If the dialed
Authorization code is verified, you will hear CO dial tone. Otherwise, you will hear error tone and can
not access the group. Stations or ADMIN programming can enter the authorization codes.
Administrator can see and change station's password. There can be no duplicate entries. By default,
Authorization Codes are not assigned at all. In IP LDK-20 system, the total number of Authorization
Codes is 200 entries.
Authorization code length can be programmed as 5 digits or variable length(3~11digits). If 5 digits
authorization code usage is programmed, authorization code works as 5 digits length in admin
program or features.
Under variable length mode, authorization code is flexible from 3 digits to 11 digits(In MPB version
2.0 or below, authorization code is fixed as 5 digits.)
379
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. 5 Digits authorization code usage(PGM 161, FLEX21)
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. Station COS : 4. 1. 7
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. Station COS : 4. 1. 7
380
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
This ADMIN program is used at CCR feature, that the caller can select the destination according to
the guiding VMIB announcement.
In LDK system, maximum 70 VMIB announcement can be used, and 8 different destination type can
be selected.
6 Internal Page 01 - 10 -
7 External Page 1 -
1: INT All Page
8 All Call Page 1–3 - 2: EXT All Page
3: All Page
09 Net Number Net Number -
10 Conference
1–9 -
Room
Reference
1. CCR(Customer Call Routing) with VMIB : 2.1.5
4.11.2.1 Station
Description
If CCR destination type is the STATION, the call is ringing at station of this value.
PROCEDURE
Description
381
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
If CCR destination type is the HUNT GROUP, the call is ringing at member station of this value hunt
group.
PROCEDURE
4.11.2.3 VMIB
Description
If CCR destination type is the VMIB, VMIB announcement of this value is played to the caller.
PROCEDURE
Description
If CCR destination type is the VMIB DROP, VMIB announcement of this value is played to the caller
and the call is disconnected when VMIB announcement ended.
PROCEDURE
Description
382
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
If CCR destination type is the SYSTEM SPEED, the call is routed to the system speed telephone
number.
PROCEDURE
Description
If CCR destination type is the INTERNAL PAGE, the call can page to the internal page zone of this
value.
PROCEDURE
Description
If CCR destination type is the EXTERNAL PAGE, the call can page to the external page zone of this
value.
PROCEDURE
Description
If CCR destination type is the ALL CALL PAGE, the call can page to the all page zone.
383
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
Description
PROCEDURE
Description
PROCEDURE
Description
384
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Value : 01~06
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. Executive/Secretary : 2.9.1
This ADMIN program is used at DID feature – DID type2. The example of ADMIN programming is
illustrated at Section 2.1.3, too.
In LDK system, maximum 1000 Flexible DID Table entry can be programmed. Each Flexible DID
Table entry has five attributes ‘DID Name’, ’Day Destination’, ’Night Destination’, ’Weekend
Destination’ and ’Reroute Destination’.
Reference
1. DID(Direct Inward Dialing) : 2.1.3
Description
Max. 11 characters
. – 13 A – 21 D – 31
Q – 11 B – 22 E – 32
Z – 12 C – 23 F – 33
1 – 10 2 – 20 3 – 30
G – 41 J – 51 M – 61
H – 42 K – 52 N – 62
I – 43 L – 53 O – 63
4 – 40 5 – 50 6 – 60
P – 71 W – 91
T – 81
R – 72 X – 92
U – 82
S – 73 Y – 93
V – 83
Q - 7½ Z – 9#
8 – 80
7 – 70 9 – 90
½1–Blank
½2 - : 0 – 00 #
½3 - ,
385
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
Description
This value is used to set the destination, when route DID call during day ring mode. The nine
different destination type can be selected.
PROCEDURE
Description
This value is used to set the destination, when route DID call during night ring mode. The nine
different destination type can be selected.
386
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
Description
This value is used to set the destination, when route DID call during weekend ring mode. The nine
different destination type can be selected.
PROCEDURE
Description
This value is used to set the second destination, when routed DID call destination is busy.
387
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
- 5: SPD (2000~2499)
- 6: Net Number (Network station number)
PROCEDURE
This ADMIN program is used at SYSTEM SPEED ZONE feature (Ref Section 2.5.5).
Description
The system speed zone can be grouped the maximum 10 system speed zone.
About each system speed zone, the accessibility can be set at ADMIN program 232 – FLEX 2.
The toll check of each system speed zone can be set at ADMIN program 232 – FLEX 4.
And the account code to access each system speed zone can be set at ADMIN program 232 – FLEX
5.
But, the system speed bin section between 2000 and 2199 is defined the toll free zone.
The system speed dial within this zone isn’t checked by the toll table.
PROCEDURE
Description
The accessibility of the system speed zones can be assigned to each station.
PROCEDURE
388
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
If this value is set to ON, the speed dial of this zone is checked by the toll table.
PROCEDURE
Description
If this value is set, the station user must enter this value to use the speed dial of each system speed
zone.
PROCEDURE
Description
389
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
The use of WEEKLY TIME TABLE is executed by the system attendant and each intercom tenancy
group attendant.
Maximum 16 WEEKLY TIME TABLE is exist. The first table is for the system attendant, and the
others are for the intercom tenancy group attendant.
The table is consist of 7 days, Monday/Tuesday/Wednesday/Thursday/Friday/Saturday/Sunday.
On each day, the time zone of DAY/NIGHT/WEEKEND mode can be programmed.
For example, the office work starts at 9:00(AM) and finishes at 5:00(PM) during week day. And the
weekend starts at 5:00(PM) from Friday to Sunday. In this case, the WEEKLY TIME TABLE can be
set as the following ADMIN program value.
WEEKLY TBL : MON WEEKLY TBL : TUE WEEKLY TBL : WED WEEKLY TBL : THU
D:09:00 N:17:00 W: D:09:00 N:17:00 W: D:09:00 N:17:00 W: D:09:00 N:17:00 W:
WEEKLY TBL : FRI WEEKLY TBL : SAT WEEKLY TBL : SUN
D:09:00 N: W:17:00 D: N: W:00:00 D: N: W:00:00
PROCEDURE
Description
This ADMIN program is used at the VM hunt group feature. This VOICE MAIL DIALING TABLE value
defines the interface of dialing command between LDK and the external VM device.
390
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Default value :
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. Voice Mail Group : 2.6.5
A mobile user is able to use the phone as extension of system. So he can receive the incoming call
and make the outgoing call when a user registers the mobile phone number.
Description
If this value is set to ON, the mobile extension feature is available.
PROCEDURE
391
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
+ 236 + + 1(On) +
Description
This value is used to assign the CO group to route the call to the mobile extension.
Value : CO Group
PROCEDURE
+ 236 + + CO GROUP +
Description
This value is used as the CLI of Mobile Extension.
PROCEDURE
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 320 + + 1(On) +
392
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This ADMIN value is used to retry the connection when IP LDK system detect the error during
networking connection signaling. This value is only used when the networking feature is executed
through the public switching network. This value is not used at the networking feature between direct
connected IP LDK systems.
PROCEDURE
Description
The name of calling station is sent to the called system between IP LDK systems. CNIP is displayed
on called party station LCD according to ADMIN programming. If the CNIP and CLI are received
together, CNIP is prior to CLI.
PROCEDURE
+ 320 + + 0(Off) +
Description
The name of answered station is sent to the calling system between IP LDK systems. CONP is
displayed on calling party station LCD according to ADMIN programming.
PROCEDURE
+ 320 + + 1(On) +
393
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
Select the information element type for networking supplementary service message.
FACILITY/USER-TO-USER information element can be used for networking supplementary service
message.
PROCEDURE
+ 320 + + 0(UUS) +
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 320 + + 1(On) +
Reference
Attendant Call Service(CAS) 2.16.16
Description
Reserved
PROCEDURE
+ 320 + + 1(On) +
394
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This value is used to set the networking supplementary signaling type of the call completion.
If this value is set to ON, the signaling of call completion retain mode is executed.
PROCEDURE
+ 320 + + 1(On) +
Reference
Call Completion 2.16.10
Description
At international standard of the networking transfer signaling, two kinds of signaling type are exist.
The name of each signaling type is REROUTE and JOIN.
This value is used to select the signaling type of networking transfer.
PROCEDURE
+ 321 + + 0(Join) +
Description
395
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
This ADMIN program is used to set the TCP port for BLF message.
PROCEDURE
Reference
BLF(Busy Lamp Field) Presentation : 2.16.19
Description
PROCEDURE
Reference
BLF(Busy Lamp Field) Presentation : 2.16.19
Description
PROCEDURE
396
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Reference
BLF(Busy Lamp Field) Presentation : 2.16.19
Description
Value : 01~20(sec)
PROCEDURE
+ 321 + + Value(sec) +
Reference
BLF(Busy Lamp Field) Presentation : 2.16.19
Description
PROCEDURE
Reference
BLF(Busy Lamp Field) Presentation : 2.16.19
Description
397
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Value : 001~300(sec)
PROCEDURE
+ 321 + + Value(sec) +
Description
This ADMIN program is used to select CO Line Group for networking call.
PROCEDURE
Description
This ADMIN program is used to select the type of system that is connected through the networking
CO line.
The system type can be separated two type. The first one is NET type, that is the networking
software installed private system. The second one is PSTN type, that is the public switching network
system.
PROCEDURE
At this ADMIN program, the numbering routing table for the networking connection can be set.
NETWORKING ROUTING TABLE has 72 entries, and each entry is consisted of 7 attributes,
‘SYSTEM USAGE’, ‘NETWORKING NUMBERING CODE’, ‘NETWORKING NUMBER CO LINE
398
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
GROUP’, CPN or IP INFORMATION’, ‘ALTERNATE SPEED DIAL BIN’, ‘DESTINATION MPB IP’, and
‘DIGIT REPEAT’.
Description
This ADMIN program is used to set the networking connection type of the selected table entries.
If PSTN is directly connected, this value must be set to PSTN.
If the networking software installed system is directly connected, this value must be set to NET.
The example of NETWORKING ADMIN program is illustrated at ‘Section 2.16.1’.
PROCEDURE
Description
This ADMIN program is used to set the networking number code of the selected table entries.
‘*’ means any digits can be inserted between 0 ~ 9.
The digits followed by ‘#’ is a internal station number.
The example of NETWORKING ADMIN program is illustrated at ‘Section 2.16.1’.
PROCEDURE
Description
This ADMIN program is used to select CO line group for networking call.
If networking call number corresponding NET NUMBERING CODE is entered, the networking call
route to the destination through this CO Line Group.
The example of NETWORKING ADMIN program is illustrated at ‘Section 2.16.1’.
399
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
Description
CPN information for ISDN, IP address for VoIP (CPN info 1 ~ CPN info 4)
The example of NETWORKING ADMIN program is illustrated at ‘Section 2.16.1’.
PROCEDURE
Description
Alternative Dial Number (System SPD Bin) when the networking path has a fatal problem.
The example of NETWORKING ADMIN program is illustrated at ‘Section 2.16.1’.
PROCEDURE
Description
400
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
Description
If this PSTN number is not connected with PSTN line directly but connected by another networking
system, make ‘Digit Repeat’ to YES.
The example of NETWORKING ADMIN program is illustrated at ‘Section 2.16.1’.
Default value : No
PROCEDURE
Description
During transit-out, this admin value determines the CLI number which is sent to PX.
PROCEDURE
At this ADMIN program, the VOIP board can be installed. Maximum 3 VOIP boards can be installed.
The VOIP board ADMIN program is consisted of 10 attributes, ‘IP ADDRESS’, ‘GATEWAY
ADDRESS’, ‘SUBNET MASK’, ‘DNS ADDRESS’, ‘TRACE PASSWORD’, ‘DEFAULTE CODEC’,
401
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
PROCEDURE
+ 340 + + Value +
Description
This ADMIN program is used at setting the gateway address of VOIP board.
PROCEDURE
+ 340 + + Value +
Description
This ADMIN program is used at setting the subnet mask of VOIP board.
PROCEDURE
+ 340 + + Value +
402
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
This ADMIN program is used at setting the DNS address of VOIP board.
PROCEDURE
+ 340 + + Value +
Description
This ADMIN program is used at setting the password which need to contact to VOIP board for trace.
Value : 10 Characters(Password)
. – 13 A – 21 D – 31
Q – 11 B – 22 E – 32
Z – 12 C – 23 F – 33
1 – 10 2 – 20 3 – 30
G – 41 J – 51 M – 61
H – 42 K – 52 N – 62
I – 43 L – 53 O – 63
4 – 40 5 – 50 6 – 60
P – 71 W – 91
T – 81
R – 72 X – 92
U – 82
S – 73 Y – 93
V – 83
Q - 7½ Z – 9#
8 – 80
7 – 70 9 – 90
½1–Blank
½2 - : 0 – 00 #
½3 - ,
PROCEDURE
Description
This ADMIN program is used at setting the default codec of VOIP board.
403
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
+ 340 + + Value +
Description
This ADMIN program is used at setting the default codec of VOIP board.
Value : 1~62
PROCEDURE
+ 340 + + Value +
4.13.1.8 No Delay(TOS)
Description
This ADMIN program is used at selecting whether the response of VOIP board will be delayed or not.
PROCEDURE
+ 340 + + 1(On) +
4.13.1.9 Throughput(TOS)
Description
This ADMIN program is used at selecting whether the throughput of VOIP board is high or normal.
PROCEDURE
404
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
+ 340 + + 1(High) +
4.13.1.10 Reliability(TOS)
Description
This ADMIN program is used at selecting whether the reliability of VOIP board is high or normal.
PROCEDURE
The VOIB slot and VOIB channel for RSG/IP Phone can be assigned. The RSG is serviced through
VOIB. So, the VOIB for RSG should be assigned.
Description
VOIB slot assignment for RSG/IP Phone (Slot number must be 09)
PROCEDURE
Description
VOIB Channel number used for RSG/IP Phone (Slot number must be 09)
Channel Range : 0 ~ 8
PROCEDURE
405
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Default Value : 0
PROCEDURE
+ 381 + + Value +
4.14.2.2 IP Phone No
Description
The IP Phone number to be serviced from system
PROCEDURE
+ 381 + + Value +
406
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Default Value : IP
PROCEDURE
+ 382 + + 0(IP) +
PROCEDURE
+ 382 + + 0(UNI) +
PROCEDURE
+ 382 + + 0(REMOTE) +
Default Value : ON
PROCEDURE
+ 382 + + 1(ON) +
407
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Default value : 0
PROCEDURE
+ 382 + + value +
Default Value : ON
PROCEDURE
+ 382 + + 1(ON) +
Default Value : ON
PROCEDURE
+ 382 + + 1(ON) +
408
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
PROCEDURE
+ 383 + Value +
PROCEDURE
409
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
+ 383 + Value +
PROCEDURE
+ 383 + Value +
PROCEDURE
+ 383 + Value +
PROCEDURE
+ 383 + Value +
PROCEDURE
+ 383 + Value +
410
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
PROCEDURE
PROCEDURE
Description
411
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
The RSG has one internal and one external MOH source. RSG associated devices use their local
MOH source in the RSG. The music will be heard when RSG devices on RSG are held or digital
keyset on RSG activates the BGM.
PROCEDURE
Description
By default, External Contacts are not assigned at all.
PROCEDURE
Reference
EXPANDED FLEXIBLE NUMBERING PLAN : 3.6.9
Description
By default, External Contacts are not assigned at all.
PROCEDURE
Reference
1. EXPANDED FLEXIBLE NUMBERING PLAN : 3.6.9
412
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
Description
When Alarm Signal is detected from RSG, the LDK system gives the Alarm Ring to the Alarm assign
station. And the alarm will be stop by Alarm Reset code.
PROCEDURE
PROCEDURE
PROCEDURE
Description
RPT means the repetition.
413
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
Description
CTI port to be assigned in RSG
PROCEDURE
PROCEDURE
4.14.5.13 IPSEC
414
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
Description
The station can receive the alarm ring when the alarm on RSG is detected.
PROCEDURE
(Range:FLEX1~FLEX8)
- Toggle
415
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
PROCEDURE
+ 386 + Value +
PROCEDURE
+ 386 + Value +
PROCEDURE
416
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
+ 386 + Value +
PROCEDURE
+ 386 + Value +
PROCEDURE
+ 386 + Value +
PROCEDURE
+ 386 + Value +
Description
CTI IP Address to support the first party CTI
417
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
4.14.7.9 IPSEC
Description
If this feature is set to ON, VOIB serves IPSEC.
PROCEDURE
PROCEDURE
+ 390 + (~ ) + Value +
418
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
+ 391 + (~ ) + Value +
419
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
+ 392 + (~ ) + Value +
420
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
+ 393 + (~ ) + Value +
421
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
+ 394 + (~ ) + Value +
422
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
+ 395 + (~ ) + Value +
423
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
+ 396 + (~ ) + Value +
424
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
PROCEDURE
+ 397 + (~ ) + Value +
425
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
426
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
6 ACOB/RESERV 00 – 63 32
7 ACOB/DCO 00 – 63 42
8 ACOB/VMIB 00 – 63 41
9 ACOB/DTMF 00 – 63 35
10 ACOB/TONE 00 – 63 47
11 ACOB/MUSIC1 00 – 63 41
12 ACOB/MUSIC2 00 – 63 41
13 ACOB/MUSIC3 00 – 63 41
14 ACOB/MODEM 00 – 63 40
PGM FLEX ITEM RANGE DEFAULT REMARK
407 VMIB RX Gain
1 VMIB/DKT 00 – 63 36
2 VMIB/SLT 00 – 63 36
3 VMIB/RESERV 00 – 63 27
4 VMIB/RESERV 00 – 63 36
5 VMIB/ACO 00 – 63 36
6 VMIB/RESERV 00 – 63 23
7 VMIB/DCO 00 – 63 36
8 VMIB/MUSIC1 00 – 63 32
9 VMIB/MUSIC2 00 – 63 32
408 DTMF RC Gain
1 DTMF/SLT 00 – 63 23
2 DTMF/RESERV 00 – 63 23
3 DTMF/ACO 00 – 63 15
4 DTMF/RESERV 00 – 63 15
5 DTMF/DCO 00 – 63 24
409 EXT PAGE Gain
1 EXT PAGE/DKT 00 – 63 26
2 EXT PAGE/SLT 00 – 63 32
3 EXT PAGE/RESERV 00 – 63 32
4 EXT PAGE/RESERV 00 – 63 26
5 EXT PAGE/ACO 00 – 63 28
6 EXT PAGE/RESERV 00 – 63 28
7 EXT PAGE/DCO 00 – 63 37
8 EXT PAGE/VMIB 00 – 63 37
9 EXT PAGE/MUSIC1 00 – 63 37
10 EXT PAGE/MUSIC2 00 – 63 37
11 EXT PAGE/MUSIC3 00 – 63 37
410 CPT Gain
1 CPT/ACO 00 – 63 15
2 CPT/RESERV 00 – 63 15
3 CPT/DCO 00 – 63 24
411 MODEM Gain
1 MODEM/ACO 00 – 63 20
2 MODEM/RESERV 00 – 63 20
3 MODEM/DCO 00 – 63 24
Short SLIB Gain
412 1 Shot ACO 00 – 63 28 SAF only
2 Long ACO 00 – 63 32
413 Long SLIB Gain SAF only
1 Shot ACO 00 – 63 37
427
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
2 Long ACO 00 – 63 37
Far SLIB Gain
414 1 Shot ACO 00 – 63 45 SAF only
2 Long ACO 00 – 63 45
Short ACO Gain
1 Short SLIB 00 – 63 34
415 2 Long SLIB 00 – 63 46 SAF only
3 Far SLIB 00 – 63 52
4 DTIB 00 – 63 26
428
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
429
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual ADMIN Programming
430
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming Table
To enter user programming mode, press the [TRANS/PGM] button in a keyset or dial 5 6 3 (Programming
enter code) in a SLT.
The following numbering plan is fixed, so it cannot be changed by ADMIN Programming.
431
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming Table
432
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming Table
433
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming Table
434
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming Table
435
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming Table
436
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming Table
437
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming Table
* Note.1) If the DIP switch of the manual board detection (DIP Switch 4) is ON, system will detect the
installed board type automatically. If the DIP switch 4 is OFF, the board type code must be entered
at each slot. After manual Rack Slot assignment, user should reset the system manually.
* Note.2) Board Type Code Table:
STA CODE COL CODE STA & COL CODE Etc CODE
DTIB4 11 LCOB2 33 STIB2 52 VMIB 61
DTIB8 12 LCOB4 34 STIB1 53 AAFB 62
SLIB4 13 CBIB 54 VMIBE 64
SLIB8 14 AAFBE 65
Board type on basic MBU(Slot 1- Slot3, Slot5) and VMIB slot (slot 7) can not be changed.
438
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming Table
439
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
440
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
441
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
5.3.7 IP SETTING
PGM FLEX ITEM RANGE DEFAULT REMARK
108 1 IP Name Max 15
2 Server IP Address 12 Digits 192.168.1.1 Skip : #
3 CLI IP Address 12 Digits
4 Gateway Address 12 Digits
5 Subnet Mask 12 Digits 255.255.255.0
6 PPP Usage ON/OFF OFF
1 ID 01-11
110
2 DSS/DLS MAP – Associate STA STA #
442
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
443
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
21 CIDSLT FSK GAIN 00-20 5 FSK gain for CID SLT, Not available in LDK-20
22 CALLER Voice Over ON/OFF OFF Facility to make Voice-Over to busy station.
112 1 CO Warning Tone ON / OFF OFF In case of restricting outgoing CO call time, if
this value is set to ON, the station user
receives warning tone during CO call after
the timer expires(ADMIN 180-FLEX 22).
2 Automatic Hold ON / OFF OFF While seizing a CO line, the station user
seizes another CO line by pressing the {CO}
button. If this value is set to ON, the previous
seized CO line goes on hold automatically. In
case of Attendant , default value is ON.
3 CO Call Time ON / OFF OFF If this flag is set to ON, station’s outgoing CO
call may be disconnected when CO call
Restriction restriction timer (PGM 180-FLEX 17) expires.
4 Ind CO Line Access EN/DIS ENABLE If this value is set to ENABLE, the station
user can access individual CO line by dialing
Individual CO access code(ADMIN 107-
FLEX 8)
5 CO Line Queuing EN/DIS ENABLE When a user of station receives a busy signal
during an attempt to access a CO line, the
user may request a call back (queue) when
the CO Line is available. If this value is set to
ENABLE, the user gets the recalling from the
CO Line when it’s available.
When a user of station receives a busy signal
during an attempt to access a CO line, the
user may request a call back (queue) when
the CO Line is available. If this value is set to
ENABLE, the user gets the recalling from the
CO Line when it’s available.
6 CO PGM EN/DIS DISABLE If this value is set to ENABLE, the station
user can program CO button at its Flexible
button.
7 PLA EN/DIS ENABLE If this value is set to ENABLE, the station
user can answer calls according to the
priority (ADMIN 173).
8 Prepaid Call ON / OFF OFF If this value is set to ON, the station user can
use Prepaid Call feature (ADMIN 180-FLEX
16).
9 Speed Dial Access EN/DIS ENABLE If this value is set to ENABLE, the station
user can use system speed dial call.
10 Two Way Record ON / OFF OFF If this value is set to ON, the station user can
record the incoming and outgoing voice
during conversation.
11 Fax Mode ON / OFF OFF
If this value is set to ON, single ring is
provided and Attendant recall is not operated.
444
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
445
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
446
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
19 Long Station CLI Max 12 Logical STA If outgoing CLI is activated and CLI type is EXT(Station),
digits Number this value is used as outgoing CLI.
20 MSN Call Wait ON / OFF OFF If this value is set to ON, she receives a call waiting via
MSN..
447
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
21 LONG CLI 1 Max 16 If CLI type of outgoing CO line is set to 1, Long CLI 1 is
digits sent.
22 LONG CLI 2 Max 16 If CLI type of outgoing CO line is set to 2, Long CLI 2 is
digits sent.
448
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
449
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
G)
3 DISA Account Code ON / OFF OFF If this value is set to ON, when the
incoming CO caller tries to access
another CO Line by dialing CO Line
access code, the caller should enter
authorization code.
This is applied only when this CO
Service type is DISA.
4 CO Line Assign POL/LOOP LOOP If this value is set to ON, Polarity
Reverse is applied to the CO Line,
otherwise, Loop Start is applied to.
5 CO Line Type PBX/CO CO If this value is set to PBX, the opposite
system is PBX. Oppositely if it is set to
CO, the system is Central Office.
6 CO Line Signal Type DTMF/PULSE DTMF If this value is set to DTMF, the CO Line
signaling type is set to DTMF.
Otherwise, signaling type is set to Pulse.
7 Flash Type GROUND/LOOP LOOP This value is applied to analogue CO
Line only.
8 UNA ON / OFF OFF If this feature is set to ON, Universal
Night Answer service is applied to this
CO Line.
9 CO Line Group Account ON / OFF OFF If this value is set to ON, the CO Line
user should enter authorization code to
access this CO Line.
10 CO Tenancy Group 0-5 0 This value means ICM Tenancy group
number the station belongs to. This
station receives the CO Call.
If this value is set, separated Day/Night
ring mode is applied to the incoming CO
Call according to each ICM tenancy
group attendant’s Day/Night ring mode.
450
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
1 CO Line Name Display ON / OFF OFF If this value is set to ON and the CO Line
Name is assigned, the Name is displayed
on the station LCD when the station gets the
CO incoming call through this CO Line.
2 CO Line Name Assign Max 12 char - This value means the name of the CO Line.
3 Metering Unit 00-06 0 This value determines the Unit used to
perceive a pulse from CO Line.
4 Line Drop using CPT ON / OFF OFF If this value is set to ON, CPT checks the
incoming CO Line when answered and if
CPT detects dial tone, then system drops
the line for toll restriction.
5 CO Distinct Ring 0-4 0 If this value is not set to 0, the designated
ring tone is heard to the station when the
station gets the incoming CO Call so that
the user can distinguish incoming CO Call
and ICM Call with its different ring tone.
Each ring tone can be adjusted at ADMIN
422
6 CO Line MOH 0-9 1 This value is used at MOH of the CO Line.
7 PABX CO Dial Tone YES / NO YES If this value is set to YES, PX or PABX
provides CO Dial Tone.
Otherwise PX or PABX does not provide CO
Dial Tone. Instead, LDK system provides it.
8 PABX CO Ring Back Tone YES / NO NO If this value is set to YES, PX or PABX
provides CO Ring Back Tone.
Otherwise PX or PABX does not provide CO
Ring Back Tone. Instead, LDK system
provides it.
9 PABX CO Error Tone YES / NO NO If this value is set to YES, PX or PABX
provides CO Error Tone.
Otherwise PX or PABX does not provide CO
Error Tone. Instead, LDK system provides it.
10 PABX CO Busy Tone YES / NO NO If this value is set to YES, PX or PABX
provides CO Busy Tone.
Otherwise PX or PABX does not provide CO
Busy Tone. Instead, LDK system provides it.
11 PABX CO Announce Tone YES / NO NO If this value is set to YES, PX or PABX
provides CO Announce Tone.
Otherwise PX or PABX does not provide CO
Announce Tone. Instead, LDK system
provides it.
12 CO Flash Timer 000 – 300 050 This value provides the length of time limit
of CO Flash.
CO Flashing is available within this timer.
Otherwise, the CO Line is released. 10msec
base
13 Open Loop Detect Timer 0 – 20 0 This value provides the time limit of CO
Open Loop. 100msec base
14 Line Length LONG / SHORT SHORT This feature is used to distinguish the line
length when the CO Line length is too
variable. (SAF only)
15 DISA Answer Timer 1-9 5 The incoming DISA call is answered after
this timer expires.
451
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
452
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
453
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
146 6 DID Digit Mask 4 digits #*** When DID Conversion Type(ADMIN
(d.*,#) 143 – FLEX4) is set to 0, The
received DID digits are converted by
this value.
The number 0 ~ 9, #, * can be
entered.
# means to ignore received digit, and
* means to bypass the digit.
The length of DID Digit Mask is 4.
454
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
12 Off-net Prompt Usage ON / OFF ON If this value is set to On, off-net VMIB
announcement(prompt) will be heard when the call is
Off-net call forwarded,. It is only applied to CO-to-CO
Transfer.
13 Off-net DTMF Tone ON / OFF ON If this value is set to ON, dialing DTMF tone will be heard
to the outside caller when the call is Off-net call
forwarded. It is only applied to CO-to-CO Transfer.
14 CO Voice Path IMM/DGT DGT If this value is set to IMM(immediate), voice path is
connected immediately at the CO outgoing call,
Connect Otherwise It is connected after dialing any digits.
15 Transfer Tone RBT/MOH MOH While a call is transferred to destination station, if this
value is set to RBT, transferred station will be heard ring
back tone. Otherwise MOH will be heard.
16 CO-CO Xfer CPT ON/OFF OFF CPT tone detect at CO to CO transfer
455
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
13 CLI Information of VM SMDI ON / OFF OFF If this value is set to ON, CLI is added when
Voice Mail information is printed through
RS232 port by SMDI.
14 ACD Print Timer Unit HOUR / SEC SEC This value determines the unit of ACD Print
timer(ADMIN 161 - FLEX 10).
(1 hour or 10 seconds)
15 Set VM SMDI Type TYPE II / TYPE I TYPE I This value sets VM SMDI type.
16 Incoming Toll Check ON / OFF OFF If this value is set to ON, the system checks toll
of incoming CO call.
17 Auto FAX Transfer CO 1-8 - The programmed CO line will be used for
automatic FAX transfer.
18 DSS Indication Enable / Disable Disable If this value is set to ENABLE, LED indication
of {CO} button or {DSS} button is blocked.
(i.e. LED does not flash even if there is
incoming call to the assigned CO Line or
Station.)
This feature is not applied for direct call such
as DID/DISA.
19 UK billing mode ON/OFF OFF If this value is set to ON, UK Billing Mode is
applied. (UK only)
20 COS 7 when auth fail ON/OFF OFF If this value is set to ON, station’ COS will be
changed to 7 when invalid authorization code
is entered.
21 5 Digits Auth Code usage ON/OFF OFF Authorization code length code can be chosen.
PGM FLEX ITEM RANGE DEFAULT REMARK
162 - ADMIN Password 4 Digits - ADMIN password can be assigned to enter
ADMIN Programming mode for only
Administrator who knows the ADMIN
password. It is not assigned by default.
163 1 Alarm Enable ON / OFF OFF If this value is set to ON, Alarm is available.
2 Alarm Contact Type CLOSE / OPEN CLOSE
3 Alarm Mode ALARM / BELL ALARM
4 Alarm Signal Mode RPT / ONCE RPT If this value is set to REPEAT, the Alarm Signal
is repeated until Alarm Reset.
164 1-5 Attendant Assignment STA No. 1 : 10 Maximum 5 Attendants can be assigned
including the Main Attendants and System
Attendant. The system attendant is different
from main attendant in aspect of the call
handling and system management priority. The
system attendant has more powerful priority
than main attendant. The system and main
attendants can be assigned to each 1 and
maximum 4. So the sum of system and main
attendants should be less than 5. As default,
the System Attendant is assigned to Station
101, and others are not assigned.
165 - Auto Attendant User may set the number of the VMIB
announcement for auto attendant.
1 Auto Attendant Usage ON / OFF OFF If this value is set to ON, Auto Attendant is
activated.
456
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
2 Auto Attendant VMIB Annc.# 00-70 00 This value is the number of VMIB
(not_asgn) announcement played when Auto Attendant is
activated.
166 CO-to-CO COS 1-9 1 When an external user of DID/DISA/TIE line
tries to access another CO Line in the system,
CO-to-CO COS is applied. The attributes of
CO-to-CO COS are the same as the station
COS.
1 Day COS 1-9 1 Class-of-Service of Day Mode
2 Night/Weekend COS 1-9 1 Class-of-Service of Night / Weekend Mode
457
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
5 Reroute Busy F1-F3 F1 When DID/DISA call is rerouted by no answer and routed
Destination destination is busy, this call is rerouted to destination by
reroute busy destination (Tone/Attendant / Hunt).
6 Reroute Error F1-F3 F1 When DID/DISA call is rerouted by no answer and routed
Destination destination is error, this call is rerouted to destination by
reroute busy destination (Tone/Attendant / Hunt).
7 Reroute No Answer F1-F3 F1 When DID/DISA call is rerouted by no answer and routed
Destination destination does not answer, this call is rerouted to
destination by reroute no answer destination
(Tone/Attendant / Hunt).
168 8 1 First Contact 1-3 - 1: LBC(STA #)
2 Second Contact 1-3 - 2: Door
3: Ext. 1
458
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
3 Incoming CO 1–4 3
4 Queued CO 1–4 4
174 RS-232 PORT Baud Rate, CTS/RTS, P-Break, LPP can be assigned at this
Setting feature to COM1 port, COM2 – MODU port.
1 BAUDRATE 0-7(Note1) 19200 0: UNKNOWN
1: UNKNOWN
2: 1200 BAUD
3: 2400 BAUD
4: 4800 BAUD
5: 9600 BAUD
6: 19200 BAUD
7: 38400 BAUD
2 CTS/RTS ON / OFF OFF
3 P-BREAK ON / OFF OFF
4 LPP 001-199 060
459
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
2 SMDR Print Enable ON / OFF OFF If this value is set to ON, SDMR data can be
printed real time through the
serial/MODEM/LAN port.
3 SMDR Recording Call LD / ALL Call LD If this value is set to LD, only long distance
Type outgoing CO call is served SMDR.
If this value is set to ALL, all outgoing CO call is
served SMDR.
The long distance call is defined that the call
satisfy the condition of ADMIN program 177 –
FLEX 4, or ADMIN program 177 – FLEX 14.
4 SMDR Long Distance 07-15 07 The long distance call is defined that the call
Call Digit Counter satisfy the condition of ADMIN program 177 –
FLEX 4, or ADMIN program 177 – FLEX 14.
If digit counters of the outgoing CO call are
more than this value, it is considered as long
distance call.
5 Print Incoming Call ON / OFF OFF If value is set to ON, all incoming calls are
printed.
460
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
13 SMDR Hidden Digit Right/Left Right If this value is set to RIGHT, SDMR digit hiding is
executed the right-to-left direction.
At this case, if dialed ‘1234567890’, SDMR printed
hidden digits are formatted ‘12345*****’.
If this value is set to LEFT, SDMR digit hiding is
executed to left-to-right direction.
At this case, if dialed ‘1234567890’, SDMR printed
hidden digits are formatted ‘*****67890’.
14 SMDR Long Flex. FLEX 1-5 0 The long distance call is defined that the call satisfy
Distance Codes the condition of ADMIN program 177 – FLEX 4, or
ADMIN program 177 – FLEX 14.
Max. 5 SMDR long distance codes are available.
SMDR long distance code is 1 or 2 digit number. By
default, SMDR long distance code is 0.
15 MSN Print On ON/OFF OFF If this value is set to ON, the MSN number is
SMDR printed on SMDR output.
16 PRINT CALLER ON/OFF ON If this value is set to ON, the caller number is
NUMBER printed at incoming call SMDR.
178 1 System Time 4 digits - Hour/Min in sequence( ex. In case 11:30, enter
Setting 1130 )
2 System Date 6 digits - Month/Day/Year in sequence( ex. In case
Setting 27/January/2004, enter 270104)
179 1 Review Linked 10-35 None The linked station pair is defined section 2.9.2.
Station Pairs Review of the programmed linked station pairs can
2 Linked station pair 2 STA # - be accessed at flexible button 1 sub-menu.
delete Registration and delete of the linked station pairs
can be set at flexible button 2 sub-menu.
461
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
5 I-Hold Recall Timer 000 – 300 030 When recalled call don’t answer, the call will
(3 digits) (sec) recall to attendant after setting time passes.
Therefore This ADMIN program set the
appropriate time.
Select the amount of time before a call recalls
the attendant
6 Sys Hold Recall Timer 000 – 300 030 Determines the amount of time before a call
(3 digits) (sec) placed on system hold will recall the station
placing the hold.
7 Transfer Recall Timer 000 – 300 030 Select the amount of time a transferred call will
(3 digits) (sec) ring at the station receiving the transfer and
how long it will recall the station transferring the
call.
8 ACNR Delay Timer 000 – 300 030 When ACNR Pause Timer expires and there is
(3 digits) (sec) no available CO Line in the group, ACNR trial is
delayed for this timer .
9 ACNR No Answer Timer 10 – 50 30 This timer is invoked after system detects CO
(2 digits) (sec) ring back tone from CO party. If the call isn’t
answered, system disconnect the call. And wait
next ACNR trial.
10 ACNR Pause Timer 005 – 300 005 When this timer is expired, ACNR is activated.
(3 digits) (sec)
11 ACNR Retry Counter 01 – 30 10 ACNR is executed up to this value. After trial of
(2 digits) this retry counter, ACNR is canceled.
12 ACNR No Tone Retry 1–9 3 This ADMIN program can set the trial number
Counter (1 digit) of seizing the CO line for ACNR. If the CO line
isn’t seized, ACNR will be canceled.
462
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
463
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
9 MSG Wait Reminder Tone 00 – 60 00 Select the amount of time between repeated
Timer (2 digits) (min) reminder tones to station that it has a message
waiting.
10 Paging Timeout Timer 000 – 255 000 Select the maximum time of a page. The
(3 digits) (sec) system will automatically disconnect the page
at the end of this time unless the caller has
hung up earlier.
11 Pause Timer 1–9 3 This timer is used at the speed dialing feature,
(1 digit) (sec) LNR, and etc. In case of the speed dial or LNR,
LDK system sends the dial digits to the
outgoing CO line, after this time.
12 Preset Call Forward Timer 00 – 99 10 This timer is used at the preset call forward
(2 digits) (sec) feature(Section 2.3.1.9). After this timer expires,
incoming call will be forwarded to a
predetermined station.
13 SLT DTMF Release Timer 00 – 20 00 DTMF RCVR will be released after this timer
(2 digits) (sec) when SLT makes a outgoing CO call.
14 3 soft auto release timer 01 – 30 05 This timer is used only in 3soft BTN DKTU(LDH-
(2 digits) (sec) 30DH). In 3soft menu, if there is no any digit
within time, the DKTU turn to Idle state.
15 VM pause timer 01 – 90 30 In-band digit stream is sent to external VM after
(2 digits) (100ms) this timer.
04 Master sends the connect message to slave
16 Transit Connect Tmr 1 – 30 system after this timer when the transit out CO
type is a pulse analog trunk.
17 VMIB msg Fwd/Rew(sec) 1 – 99 05 VMIB message is rewound as this timer.
464
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
465
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
466
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
467
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
tone.
14 Alternate Station/Hunt Grp - When a call is received in the group
Destination and there is no available station in the
group, then the call will be routed to this
destination if assigned
15 Max Queue Call 00-99 99 This value is the maximum call count
Count that can be queued.
If the total queued call count is this
value, the next queuing tried call will be
disconnected.
UCD 1 VMIB Announce 000-999 015 If the call doesn’t answered during this
Group 1 Timer (3 digits) (sec) timer, the system plays VMIB
announcement that is programmed at
ADMIN program 191 – FLEX 3.
468
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
469
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
470
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
471
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
472
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
6 CLI Print ON/OFF OFF This value is used to execute the CLI print
about the incoming CO call.
If this value is set to ON, the CLI of the
incoming CO call will be sent to
serial/MODEM/LAN port.
7 International Access Code Max 4 digits - This value is used to modify the received CLI
of the international incoming CO call.
If this value is set, and if station receives the
international incoming CO call, then this
value is inserted in front of the CLI.
8 Reserved - - Moved to PGM 146
9 My Area Code Max 6 digits - This value is used to set the my area code.
The combination of this value and ADMIN
program 200 – FLEX 10 is compared with the
received CLI, and the received CO call can
be judged the local call or the long distance
call.
This value is also used the outgoing CLI
data, when station makes an outgoing CO
call.
10 My Area Prefix Code Max 4 digits - This value is used to set the my area prefix
code. (Normally zero value)
The combination of this value and ADMIN
program 200 – FLEX 9 is compared with the
received CLI, and the received CO call can
be judged the local call or the long distance
call.
This value is also used the outgoing CLI
data, when station makes an outgoing CO
call.
PGM FLEX ITEM RANGE DEFAULT REMARK
200 11 Maintain DID Name ON/OFF OFF This value is used at the CLI display of
incoming DID CO call.
If the incoming DID call has CLI, it is
displayed on station LCD only ringing time.
If this value is set to ON, CLI display is
maintained when the call is answered.
12 This value is used the valid destination
PC APPLICATION
STN 100 station about PC application connection
DESTINATION STATION
request.
201 - COLP Table Max. 10 digits - COLP table is used when makes the
outgoing CLI
The method of making CLI is explained at
‘Section 2.14.2’.
At this ADMIN program, the maximum 50 CLI
data can be programmed.
And this value is used at ADMIN program
143 – FLEX 1 and 2.
473
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
202 - MSN Table Entry No.(000-249) - MSN(Ref Section 2.14.7 and 2.14.8) is
defined one of ISDN CO line service.
In LDK system, maximum 250 MSN table
entry can be programmed.
Each MSN table entry has MSN ‘CO line
number’, ‘Index of flexible DID table’,
‘Subaddress number’, and ‘Telephone
number’.
1 CO Line number 01-08 - This value is used to set CO line that is
assigned MSN service.
2 Index of Flexible DID 000-999 - If the received digit of Incoming CO call is
Table matched MSN telephone number(ADMIN
PGM 202 – FLEX 4), it is MSN call.
This value is used to search the destination
of MSN call routing.
This value indicates the entry index of flexible
DID table(ADMIN program 231).
3 SUB Number 0-9 - This value is only used when the destination
station type is ISDN telephone.
If the destination is ISDN telephone, this
value is sent as the ISDN sub-address
number of it.
4 TEL number 20 digits - This value is ISDN MSN number.
If the received digit of Incoming CO call is
matched with this value, it is MSN call.
203 1 TEI type Fixed/Auto Auto This value controls the type of Terminal
Equipment Identification.
2 Hold/Retrieve Service Keypad/Functional Keypad This sets the service type for ISDN
3 Hold Code Max. 10 digits *75# This stores the code for ISDN supplementary
HOLD.
4 Retrieve Code Max. 10 digits *76# This stores the code for ISDN supplementary
RETRIEVE.
474
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
475
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
1 Time Zone1 00 – 24 0024 Each time of day zone1 can use different LCR setting.
At this ADMIN program, each time of day zone1 can be
grouped up to 3 zone.
2 Time Zone2 00 – 24 Each time of day zone2 can use different LCR setting.
At this ADMIN program, each time of day zone2 can be
grouped up to 3 zone.
3 Time Zone3 00 – 24 Each time of day zone3 can use different LCR setting.
At this ADMIN program, each time of day zone3 can be
grouped up to 3 zone.
221 Leading Digit Table 000-249
1 LCR Type 1–3 3 This value is used to select the LCR type.
2 LCR Code Max 12 digits - If digits that is dialed by user are equal to this value, the
(leading digit) digits is converted and CO line is seized according to
DMT(ADMIN program 222).
3 Day Zone 1 DMT 6digits - This value is used to set the table index DMT(ADMIN
program 222) of the day zone 1.
Because day zone 1 has 3 different time zone, three table
index of each time must be selected.
The example of this ADMIN programming is illustrated at
‘Section 2.7’.
4 Day Zone 2 DMT 6digits - This value is used to set the table index DMT(ADMIN
program 222) of the day zone 2.
Because day zone 2 has 3 different time zone, three table
index of each time must be selected.
The example of this ADMIN programming is illustrated at
‘Section 2.7’.
5 Day Zone 3 DMT 6digits - This value is used to set the table index DMT(ADMIN
program 222) of the day zone 2.
Because day zone 2 has 3 different time zone, three table
index of each time must be selected.
The example of this ADMIN programming is illustrated at
‘Section 2.7’.
6 Check password ON/OFF OFF If this value is set to ON, LDK system request the account
code of user, when dialed digit is matched LCR code.
476
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
3 Number Of Remove 01 – 12 00 This value is used to set the remove digit count at user
dialed digits.
Some digits are removed as much as this value from the
position of ‘Removal Position’ (ADMIN program 222 –
FLEX 2).
The example of this ADMIN programming is illustrated at
‘Section 2.7’.
4 Add Position 1 – 13 1 This value is used to set the add position at user dialed
digits.
Some digits are added from the this position with ‘Add
Digit Stream’ (ADMIN program 222 – FLEX 1).
The example of this ADMIN programming is illustrated at
‘Section 2.7’.
5 CO Line Group 1–8 1 This value is used when LCR call seize the outgoing CO
line.
The idle CO line within CO Line Group of this value is
seized for LCR call.
The example of this ADMIN programming is illustrated at
‘Section 2.7’.
6 Alternative DMT 00 – 99 This value is used when LCR call can’t seize the idle CO
Index line within ADMIN program 222 – FLEX 5.
- If LCR call can’t seize the idle CO line within LCR CO
Line Group, LCR call seize the idle CO within CO Line
Group of this value DMT index.
477
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
478
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
479
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
Int Page
Ext Page
All Page
Net Num
Conf Room
3 Night Destination STA # / Hunt # / ATD STA # This value is used to set the destination, when
VMIB # / route DID call during night ring mode. The nine
VMIB # drop
different destination type can be selected.
SPD
Int Page
Ext Page
All Page
Net Num
Conf Room
4 Weekend STA # / Hunt # / ATD STA # This value is used to set the destination, when
Destination VMIB # / route DID call during weekend ring mode. The
VMIB # drop
nine different destination type can be selected.
SPD
Int Page
Ext Page
All Page
Net Num
Conf Room
5 Reroute STA # / Hunt # / ATD STA # This value is used to set the second destination,
Destination VMIB # / when routed DID call destination is busy.
VMIB # drop
SPD
480
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
System Speed
232 01-10
Zone
1 Speed Bin Range 2200 – 2499 The system speed zone can be grouped the
in Zone maximum 10 system speed zone.
About each system speed zone, the
accessibility can be set at ADMIN program 232
– FLEX 2.
The toll check of each system speed zone can
be set at ADMIN program 232 – FLEX 4.
And the account code to access each system
speed zone can be set at ADMIN program 232
– FLEX 5.
But, the system speed bin section between
2000 and 2199 is defined the toll free zone.
The system speed dial within this zone isn’t
checked by the toll table.
2 Station Range STA No. 10-35 The accessibility of the system speed zones
can be assigned to each station.
3 Toll Checking ON/OFF ON If this value is set to ON, the speed dial of this
zone is checked by the toll table.
4 Authorization If this value is set, the station user must enter
check this value to use the speed dial of each system
speed zone.
233 Weekly Time 1–7 - This ADMIN program is used at the ring
Table assignment feature(Ref Section 2.1.1).
1 Day Start Time 0000 – 2359 0900 The WEEKLY TIME TABLE can manage the
2 Night Start Time 0000 – 2359 1800 ring mode changes automatically.
3 Weekend Start 0000 – 2359 The use of WEEKLY TIME TABLE is executed
Time
by the system attendant and each intercom
tenancy group attendant.
Maximum 16 WEEKLY TIME TABLE is exist.
The first table is for the system attendant, and
the others are for the intercom tenancy group
attendant.
The table is consist of 7 days,
Monday/Tuesday/Wednesday/Thursday/Friday/
Saturday/Sunday.
On each day, the time zone of
DAY/NIGHT/WEEKEND mode can be
programmed.
For example, the office work starts at 9:00(AM)
and finishes at 5:00(PM) during week day. And
the weekend starts at 5:00(PM) from Friday to
Sunday. In this case, the WEEKLY TIME TABLE
can be set as the following ADMIN program
value.
481
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
234 Voice Mail Dial-Table 1-9 This ADMIN program is used at the VM hunt
1 Prefix Index 12 Digits - group feature. This VOICE MAIL DIALING TABLE
2 Suffix Index 12 Digits - value defines the interface of dialing command
between LDK and the external VM device.
236 Mobile Extension
Table
1 Mobile Extension ON/OFF OFF If this value is set to ON, the station can use the
mobile extension feature.
Enable
2 Mobile Extension CO 1–8 Assign CO group when a call routes to a mobile
extension.
Group.
3 Mobile Extension Tel Max 24 Assign the telephone number of mobile extension.
No
4 Mobile EXT CLI No - - This value is used as the CLI of Mobile Extension
482
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
483
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
484
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
485
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
486
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
487
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
488
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
489
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
8 RSG_LCO TX to VMIB 00 – 63
396 IP PHONE RX Gain
1 IP PHONE RX from DKTU 00 – 63
2 IP PHONE RX from SLT 00 – 63
3 IP PHONE RX from CTR_SLT 00 – 63
4 IP PHONE RX from WKT 00 – 63
5 IP PHONE RX from ACO 00 – 63
6 IP PHONE RX from CTR_ACO 00 – 63
7 IP PHONE RX from DCO 00 – 63
8 IP PHONE RX from VMIB 00 – 63
9 IP PHONE RX from DTMF 00 – 63
10 IP PHONE RX from TONE 00 – 63
11 IP PHONE RX from MUSIC 1 00 – 63
12 IP PHONE RX from MUSIC 2 00 – 63
13 IP PHONE RX from RSG_DKT 00 – 63
14 IP PHONE RX from RSG_SLT 00 – 63
15 IP PHONE RX from RSG_LCO 00 – 63
16 IP PHONE RX from IP Phone 00 – 63
397 IP PHONE TX Gain
1 IP PHONE TX to DKTU 00 – 63
2 IP PHONE TX to SLT 00 – 63
3 IP PHONE TX to CTR_SLT 00 – 63
4 IP PHONE TX to WKT 00 – 63
5 IP PHONE TX to ACO 00 – 63
6 IP PHONE TX to CTR_ACO 00 – 63
7 IP PHONE TX to DCO 00 – 63
8 IP PHONE TX to VMIB 00 – 63
490
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
491
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
492
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
493
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
5.3.26 INITIALIZATION
PGM FLEX ITEM RANGE DEFAULT REMARK
450 Initialization
1 Flexible Numbering Plan Initialization PGM105, PGM106, PGM107
2 Station Database Initialization PGM110, PGM111, PGM112, PGM113,
PGM114, PGM 116, PGM117, PGM118,
PGM119, PGM121,PGM122, PGM123,
PGM124, PGM179
3 CO Line Database Initialization PGM140, PGM141, PGM142, PGM143,
PGM144
4 System Feature Database Initialization PGM160 – PGM 177, PGM108
5 Station Group Database Initialization PGM190, PGM191
6 ISDN Tables Database Initialization PGM201, PGM202, PGM230, PGM231
7 Reserved None(Reserved)
8 System Timer Database Initialization PGM180 – PGM182
9 Toll Table Database Initialization PGM224, PGM225
10 LCR Database Initialization PGM220 – PGM222
11 Tables Initialization PGM227 – PGM229,
PGM232 – PGM235
12 Flexible Button Program Initialization PGM115
13 Networking Database Initialization PGM 320, PGM321,PGM322,PGM323, PGM
324
14 All Database Initialization Above All
15 System Reset By Software
16 DID Reroute Table
17 Board DATA
494
IP LDK-20 Programming Manual Quick ADMIN Programming table
495